]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
34bbf3d1a3710a69fc97f5294b6def7972602196
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111 \f
112 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
113
114 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
115 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
116 the fancy startup screen.
117
118 +++
119 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
120 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
121 the blinking cursor.
122
123 +++
124 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
125 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
126
127 +++
128 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
129 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
130 can start with this line:
131
132 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
133
134 +++
135 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
136 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
137 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
138
139 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
140
141 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
142 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
143
144 +++
145 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
146 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
147
148 +++
149 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
150 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
151 an interactively callable function.
152
153 +++
154 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
155 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
156 affects the initial frame.
157
158 +++
159 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
160 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
161 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
162 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
163 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
164
165 +++
166 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
167 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
168 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
169 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
170 `inhibit-splash-screen').
171
172 +++
173 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
174 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
175 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
176
177 +++
178 ** Init file changes
179 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
180 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
181
182 +++
183 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
184 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
185 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
186 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
187 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
188 \f
189 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
190
191 +++
192 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
193 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
194 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
195 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
196
197 +++
198 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
199 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
200
201 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
202 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
203
204 +++
205 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
206 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
207 the operating system or your X server.
208
209 +++
210 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
211
212 +++
213 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
214 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
215 you about it.
216
217 +++
218 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
219 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
220
221 +++
222 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
223 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
224 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
225
226 +++
227 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
228 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
229
230 +++
231 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
232
233 See below under "incremental search changes".
234
235 ---
236 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
237
238 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
239 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
240 directory with Dired.
241
242 +++
243 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
244 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
245 it remains unchanged.
246
247 +++
248 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
249 M-o M-o requests refontification.
250
251 +++
252 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
253
254 See below for more details.
255
256 +++
257 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
258 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
259 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
260 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
261 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
262 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
263 \f
264 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
265
266 +++
267 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
268 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
269
270 +++
271 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
272 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
273 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
274 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
275
276 +++
277 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
278 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
279
280 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
281 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
282
283 +++
284 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
285 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
286 the operating system or your X server.
287
288 +++
289 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
290
291 +++
292 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
293 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
294 you about it.
295
296 +++
297 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
298 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
299
300 +++
301 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
302 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
303 can be used as well.
304
305 +++
306 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
307
308 +++
309 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
310 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
311
312 ---
313 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
314 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
315
316 ---
317 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
318 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
319
320 +++
321 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
322 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
323 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
324 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
325
326 +++
327 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
328 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
329 in Indented-Text mode.
330
331 +++
332 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
333
334 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
335 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
336 in the value, use `$$'.
337
338 +++
339 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
340 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
341 `same-window'.
342
343 +++
344 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
345 from the locale.
346
347 ** Mark command changes:
348
349 +++
350 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
351 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
352 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
353
354 +++
355 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
356
357 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
358 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
359 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
360 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
361 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
362 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
363 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
364 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
365 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
366
367 +++
368 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
369
370 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
371 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
372 paragraphs.
373
374 +++
375 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
376 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
377 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
378 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
379 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
380 command only.
381
382 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
383 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
384 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
385 mark or the region.
386
387 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
388 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
389 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
390 C-g.
391
392 +++
393 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
394 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
395 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
396
397 ** Help command changes:
398
399 +++
400 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
401
402 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
403
404 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
405 that do not change:
406
407 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
408 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
409
410 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
411 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
412
413 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
414
415 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
416 run by the key sequence.
417
418 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
419 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
420 that command.
421
422 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
423 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
424
425 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
426 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
427
428 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
429 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
430
431 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
432 new-kill-line is on C-k
433
434 ---
435 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
436 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
437 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
438 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
439
440 +++
441 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
442 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
443
444 +++
445 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
446 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
447 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
448 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
449 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
450 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
451 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
452
453 +++
454 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
455 description various information about a character, including its
456 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
457 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
458 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
459
460 +++
461 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
462 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
463
464 +++
465 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
466 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
467 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
468 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
469 keyboard oriented alternative.
470
471 +++
472 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
473 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
474 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
475 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
476 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
477
478 +++
479 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
480 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
481 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
482 available.
483
484 +++
485 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
486 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
487 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
488 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
489 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
490 matching item.
491
492 ** Incremental Search changes:
493
494 +++
495 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
496 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
497 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
498 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
499 for details.
500
501 +++
502 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
503 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
504 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
505 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
506
507 +++
508 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
509 at the end of a line.
510
511 +++
512 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
513 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
514 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
515
516 +++
517 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
518 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
519 search string used as the string to replace.
520
521 +++
522 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
523 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
524 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
525
526 ** Replace command changes:
527
528 ---
529 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
530 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
531 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
532
533 +++
534 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
535 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
536 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
537 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
538 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
539 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
540 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
541 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
542 can be edited for each replacement.
543
544 +++
545 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
546 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
547
548 ---
549 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
550 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
551
552 ** File operation changes:
553
554 +++
555 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
556 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
557 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
558 is only rarely needed.
559
560 +++
561 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
562 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
563
564 +++
565 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
566 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
567
568 +++
569 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
570 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
571
572 +++
573 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
574
575 ---
576 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
577
578 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
579 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
580 directory with Dired.
581
582 +++
583 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
584 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
585 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
586 file.)
587
588 +++
589 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
590 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
591
592 +++
593 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
594 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
595 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
596 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
597 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
598 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
599
600 ---
601 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
602 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
603 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
604
605 ---
606 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
607 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
608 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
609
610 +++
611 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
612 Emacs asks for confirmation.
613
614 +++
615 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
616
617 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
618 when visiting the file.
619
620 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
621 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
622 when saving the file.
623
624 +++
625 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
626 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
627 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
628 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
629 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
630 modes do.
631
632 ** Minibuffer changes:
633
634 +++
635 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
636 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
637 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
638 prompt string.
639
640 ---
641 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
642
643 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
644 have in common and where they begin to differ.
645
646 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
647 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
648 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
649 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
650 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
651 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
652 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
653 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
654
655 +++
656 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
657 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
658 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
659 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
660 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
661 candidate is a directory.
662
663 +++
664 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
665 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
666 it remains unchanged.
667
668 +++
669 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
670 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
671 elements are deleted.
672
673 ** Redisplay changes:
674
675 +++
676 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
677 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
678 appears between the position information and the major mode.
679
680 +++
681 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
682
683 +++
684 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
685 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
686 to nil.
687
688 +++
689 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
690 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
691 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
692 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
693
694 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
695 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
696 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
697 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
698 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
699 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
700
701 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
702 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
703
704 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
705 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
706 vscroll property.
707
708 +++
709 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
710 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
711 the mode line of the currently selected window.
712
713 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
714 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
715
716 +++
717 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
718 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
719 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
720 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
721 set-fringe-style.
722
723 +++
724 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
725 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
726 the window can be scrolled.
727
728 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
729 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
730 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
731
732 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
733 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
734
735 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
736 position of each bitmap individually.
737
738 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
739 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
740 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
741 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
742
743 +++
744 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
745 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
746 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
747 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
748 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
749
750 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
751 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
752
753 +++
754 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
755 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
756 outside those margins.
757
758 +++
759 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
760 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
761
762 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
763 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
764 or when the frame is resized.
765
766 ** Cursor display changes:
767
768 +++
769 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
770 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
771
772 +++
773 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
774
775 +++
776 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
777 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
778 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
779 cursor does.
780
781 +++
782 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
783 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
784 appears in.
785
786 +++
787 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
788 of the recognized cursor types.
789
790 ** Font-Lock changes:
791
792 +++
793 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
794 M-o M-o requests refontification.
795
796 +++
797 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
798 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
799 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
800
801 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
802 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
803 `Info-mode-hook'.
804
805 +++
806 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
807 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
808 The default value is 1.
809
810 +++
811 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
812 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
813 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
814 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
815 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
816
817 +++
818 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
819
820 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
821
822 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
823 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
824 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
825 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
826
827 ---
828 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
829 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
830 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
831 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
832 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
833
834 ---
835 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
836
837 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
838 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
839 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
840 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
841
842 ---
843 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
844
845 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
846 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
847 refontification takes place.
848
849 ** Menu support:
850
851 ---
852 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
853 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
854 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
855 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
856 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
857 current date and time, current line and column number in the
858 mode-line.
859
860 ---
861 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
862
863 ---
864 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
865
866 ---
867 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
868 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
869 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
870
871 +++
872 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
873 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
874
875 ---
876 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
877 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
878
879 +++
880 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
881 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
882 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
883
884 ---
885 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
886 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
887
888 +++
889 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
890 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
891 the new dialog.
892
893 ** Mouse changes:
894
895 +++
896 *** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
897 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
898 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
899 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
900 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
901 feature is not enabled.
902
903 +++
904 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
905 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
906 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
907 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
908 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
909 to give it focus.
910
911 +++
912 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
913
914 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
915 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
916 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
917 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
918 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
919 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
920
921 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
922 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
923 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
924 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
925 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
926 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
927 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
928 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
929 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
930
931 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
932 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
933 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
934 you release it).
935
936 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
937 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
938
939 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
940 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
941
942 +++
943 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
944 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
945 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
946 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
947 also disable mouse highlighting.
948
949 +++
950 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
951 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
952 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
953
954 ---
955 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
956 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
957
958 ---
959 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
960
961 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
962 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
963 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
964 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
965
966 +++
967 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
968
969 ** Mule changes:
970
971 ---
972 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
973 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
974 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
975 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
976 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
977
978 +++
979 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
980 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
981 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
982 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
983 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
984 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
985 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
986 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
987
988 +++
989 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
990 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
991
992 +++
993 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
994 coding system.
995
996 +++
997 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
998 of a file.
999
1000 ---
1001 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1002 unicode.
1003
1004 +++
1005 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1006 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1007 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1008 command.
1009
1010 +++
1011 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1012 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1013
1014 +++
1015 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1016 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1017 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1018 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1019 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1020 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1021 mule-unicode-... ones.
1022
1023 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1024 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1025 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1026 possible.
1027
1028 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1029 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1030 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1031 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1032 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1033
1034 ---
1035 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1036 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1037 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1038 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1039
1040 ---
1041 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1042 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1043 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1044 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1045 automatically according to the locale.)
1046
1047 ---
1048 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1049 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1050 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1051 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1052 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1053 tamil-inscript.
1054
1055 ---
1056 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1057 characters.
1058
1059 ---
1060 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1061 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1062 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1063 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1064 M-f (forward-word)
1065 M-b (backward-word)
1066 M-d (kill-word)
1067 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1068 M-t (transpose-words)
1069 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1070
1071 ---
1072 *** Indian support has been updated.
1073 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1074 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1075 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1076 supported.
1077
1078 ---
1079 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1080
1081 ---
1082 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1083 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1084 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1085 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1086 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1087 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1088 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1089 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1090 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1091 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1092 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1093 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1094
1095 ---
1096 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1097 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1098 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1099
1100 ---
1101 *** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1102 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1103 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1104 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1105 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1106 latter is used by GNU locales.
1107
1108 ---
1109 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1110 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1111
1112 ---
1113 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1114 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1115 fontset appropriately.
1116
1117 ** Customize changes:
1118
1119 +++
1120 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1121 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1122 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1123 faces.
1124
1125 ---
1126 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1127 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1128 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1129 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1130 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1131 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1132 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1133
1134 +++
1135 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1136 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1137 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1138 under the "[State]" button.
1139
1140 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1141
1142 +++
1143 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1144 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1145 mode.
1146
1147 +++
1148 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1149 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1150 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1151
1152 ---
1153 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1154 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1155 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1156
1157 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1158 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1159 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1160 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1161 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1162
1163 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1164 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1165 t, and the status is shown.
1166
1167 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1168 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1169
1170 ** Dired mode:
1171
1172 ---
1173 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1174 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1175 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1176
1177 +++
1178 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1179 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1180
1181 +++
1182 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1183 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1184
1185 +++
1186 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1187 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1188 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1189 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1190 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1191 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1192
1193 +++
1194 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1195 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1196
1197 +++
1198 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1199
1200 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1201 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1202 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1203 instead.
1204
1205 +++
1206 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1207 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1208 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1209 directory listing into a buffer.
1210
1211 ** Comint changes:
1212
1213 ---
1214 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1215 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1216 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1217 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1218 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1219
1220 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1221 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1222
1223 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1224 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1225 lines, including any prompts.
1226
1227 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1228 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1229 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1230 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1231 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1232 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1233 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1234
1235 +++
1236 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1237 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1238 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1239 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1240
1241 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1242 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1243 but declared obsolete.
1244
1245 ** M-x Compile changes:
1246
1247 ---
1248 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1249
1250 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1251 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1252 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1253 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1254
1255 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1256 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1257 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1258
1259 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1260 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1261 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1262 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1263 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1264
1265 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1266
1267 +++
1268 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1269 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1270 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1271 subprocesses inherit.
1272
1273 +++
1274 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1275 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1276 in new face `next-error'.
1277
1278 +++
1279 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1280 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1281 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1282 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1283 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1284 C-c C-f.
1285
1286 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1287 the compilation buffer.
1288
1289 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1290 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1291 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1292 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1293 of the window.
1294
1295 ** Occur mode changes:
1296
1297 +++
1298 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1299 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1300 switching to it.
1301
1302 +++
1303 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1304 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1305
1306 +++
1307 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1308 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1309 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1310 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1311 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1312
1313 ** Grep changes:
1314
1315 +++
1316 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1317
1318 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1319 customization group.
1320
1321 ---
1322 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1323
1324 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1325 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1326
1327 +++
1328 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1329 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1330
1331 ---
1332 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1333 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1334 settings, for grep commands only.
1335
1336 +++
1337 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1338 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1339 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1340 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1341 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1342 source line is highlighted.
1343
1344 +++
1345 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1346 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1347 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1348 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1349 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1350 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1351 file.
1352
1353 +++
1354 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1355 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1356 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1357 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1358 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1359 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1360
1361 ** X Windows Support:
1362
1363 +++
1364 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1365 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1366 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1367
1368 +++
1369 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1370 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1371 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1372 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1373 Meta and Alt:
1374 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1375 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1376
1377 +++
1378 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1379 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1380
1381 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1382 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1383
1384 ---
1385 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1386 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1387 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1388 and use the more appropriately result.
1389
1390 ---
1391 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1392 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1393 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1394
1395 ** Xterm support:
1396
1397 ---
1398 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1399 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1400
1401 ---
1402 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1403 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1404 following should work:
1405 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1406 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1407 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1408
1409 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1410
1411 +++
1412 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1413 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1414 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1415 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1416 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1417 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1418 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1419 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1420 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1421
1422 ---
1423 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1424 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1425 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1426 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1427 all of these colors.
1428
1429 +++
1430 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1431 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1432 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1433 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1434 colors as on X.
1435
1436 ---
1437 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1438 \f
1439 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1440
1441 +++
1442 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1443 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1444 program files that include other program files.
1445
1446 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1447 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1448 in them.
1449
1450 +++
1451 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1452
1453 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1454 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1455 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1456 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1457
1458 ---
1459 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1460 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1461
1462 ---
1463 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1464
1465 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1466 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1467 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1468 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1469
1470 +++
1471 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1472 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1473
1474 ---
1475 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1476
1477 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1478 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1479 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1480 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1481 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1482 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1483
1484 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1485 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1486 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1487 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1488
1489 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1490 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1491 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1492 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1493 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1494 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1495 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1496
1497 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1498 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1499 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1500
1501 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1502 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1503
1504 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1505 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1506 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1507 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1508
1509 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1510 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1511 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1512 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1513
1514 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1515 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1516 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1517 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1518
1519 +++
1520 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1521 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1522 to increment the SOA serial.
1523
1524 ---
1525 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1526 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1527 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1528 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1529 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1530 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1531
1532 +++
1533 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1534 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1535
1536 +++
1537 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1538 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1539 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1540 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1541 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1542
1543 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1544 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1545 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1546 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1547 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1548 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1549
1550 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1551 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1552 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1553 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1554 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1555 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1556 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1557 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1558 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1559 or local keymaps.
1560
1561 +++
1562 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1563 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1564
1565 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1566 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1567 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1568 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1569
1570 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1571 defined macros.
1572
1573 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1574 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1575 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1576 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1577 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1578 for more commands.
1579
1580 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1581 the keyboard macro ring.
1582
1583 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1584 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1585
1586 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1587 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1588 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1589 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1590
1591 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1592 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1593 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1594
1595 ---
1596 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1597 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1598 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1599
1600 +++
1601 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1602 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1603
1604 +++
1605 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1606 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1607 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1608 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1609 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1610 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1611 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1612 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1613 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1614
1615 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1616
1617 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1618 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1619 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1620 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1621 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1622 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1623
1624 ---
1625 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1626 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1627 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1628 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1629
1630 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1631
1632 ---
1633 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1634 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1635 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1636 settings.
1637
1638 +++
1639 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1640 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1641 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1642 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1643
1644 +++
1645 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1646 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1647
1648 +++
1649 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1650 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1651 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1652 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1653 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1654 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1655
1656 +++
1657 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1658 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1659
1660 +++
1661 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1662
1663 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1664 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1665 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1666 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1667 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1668 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1669 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1670 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1671 `rsync' to do the copying).
1672
1673 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1674 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1675
1676 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1677
1678 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1679
1680 ---
1681 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1682
1683 ---
1684 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1685 configuration files.
1686
1687 +++
1688 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1689 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1690 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1691 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1692 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1693 recognized.
1694
1695 ---
1696 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1697
1698 +++
1699 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1700
1701 ---
1702 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1703 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1704 \f
1705 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1706
1707 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1708
1709 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1710 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1711 faces.
1712
1713 +++
1714 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1715 of the file that precede the first header line.
1716
1717 +++
1718 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1719
1720 ---
1721 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1722 run most curses applications now.
1723
1724 +++
1725 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1726
1727 +++
1728 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1729 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1730 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1731
1732 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1733 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1734 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1735
1736 ---
1737 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1738 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1739
1740 ---
1741 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1742 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1743 incompatible change.
1744
1745 ---
1746 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1747
1748 +++
1749 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1750 resync points in both windows.
1751
1752 +++
1753 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1754
1755 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1756 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1757
1758 ---
1759 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1760 when Emacs visits them.
1761
1762 ** Info mode changes:
1763
1764 +++
1765 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1766 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1767
1768 ---
1769 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1770
1771 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1772 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1773 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1774 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1775 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1776 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1777 Info node.
1778
1779 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1780 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1781 search without prompting for a new search string.
1782
1783 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1784 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1785 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1786
1787 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1788
1789 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1790 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1791
1792 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1793 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1794 possible matches.
1795
1796 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1797 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1798 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1799
1800 ---
1801 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1802 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1803
1804 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1805 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1806
1807 +++
1808 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1809
1810 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1811 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1812
1813 ---
1814 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1815
1816 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1817 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1818 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1819
1820 +++
1821 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1822
1823 ---
1824 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1825
1826 ** Lisp mode changes:
1827
1828 ---
1829 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
1830
1831 +++
1832 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
1833
1834 *** New features in evaluation commands
1835
1836 +++
1837 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1838 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1839
1840 +++
1841 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1842 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1843 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1844 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1845 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1846
1847 +++
1848 ** CC mode changes.
1849
1850 *** Font lock support.
1851 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1852 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1853 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1854 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1855 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1856 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1857
1858 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1859 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1860 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1861 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1862 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1863 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1864 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1865 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1866 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1867
1868 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1869 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1870 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1871 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1872 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1873 take the better part of a minute.
1874
1875 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1876 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1877 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1878 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1879 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1880 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1881
1882 **** Support for documentation comments.
1883 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1884 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1885 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1886 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1887
1888 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1889 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1890 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1891 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1892
1893 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1894 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1895 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1896 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1897 parens.
1898
1899 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1900 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1901 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1902 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1903 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1904
1905 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1906 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1907 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1908 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1909 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1910
1911 *** Support for the AWK language.
1912 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1913 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1914 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1915 Here is a summary:
1916
1917 **** Indentation Engine
1918 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1919
1920 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1921 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1922 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1923 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1924 definition, or structured statement.
1925
1926 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1927 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1928 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1929
1930 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1931 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1932 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1933 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1934
1935 **** Font Locking
1936 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1937 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1938 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1939 the AWK language itself.
1940
1941 **** Comment Commands
1942 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1943 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1944
1945 **** Movement Commands
1946 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1947 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1948 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1949
1950 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1951 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1952 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1953 functions.
1954
1955 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1956 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1957 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1958 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1959
1960 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1961 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1962 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1963 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1964 composition-close, and incomposition.
1965
1966 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1967 The functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward' can be
1968 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1969
1970 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
1971
1972 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
1973 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
1974 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
1975 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
1976
1977 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
1978 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
1979
1980 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1981
1982 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
1983 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
1984 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1985 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1986
1987 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1988
1989 is now analysed as
1990
1991 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1992
1993 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1994 symbol.
1995
1996 This change might affect code that call `c-guess-basic-syntax' directly,
1997 and custom lineup functions if they use `c-syntactic-context'. However,
1998 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1999 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2000
2001 *** API changes for derived modes.
2002
2003 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2004 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2005 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2006 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2007 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2008
2009 **** New language variable system.
2010 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2011
2012 **** New initialization functions.
2013 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2014 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2015 `c-init-language-vars'.
2016
2017 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2018 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2019 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2020 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2021
2022 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2023 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2024 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2025 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2026 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2027
2028 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2029 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2030 its substatement. E.g:
2031
2032 if (x)
2033 x_is_true:
2034 do_stuff();
2035
2036 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2037
2038 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2039 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2040 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2041 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2042 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2043 inside `#define's.
2044
2045 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2046
2047 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2048 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2049 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2050 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2051 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2052 empty lines within the macro better.
2053
2054 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2055 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2056 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2057
2058 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2059 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2060 variable `c-backslash-max-column' which put a limit on how far out
2061 backslashes can be moved.
2062
2063 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2064 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2065 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2066 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2067 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2068
2069 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2070 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2071 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2072 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2073 backslash) in the macro.
2074
2075 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2076 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2077 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior based
2078 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2079 and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other cases
2080 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2081
2082 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2083 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2084
2085 *** New lineup functions
2086
2087 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2088 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2089 continues. E.g:
2090
2091 result = prefix + "A message "
2092 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2093
2094 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2095 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2096
2097 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2098 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2099 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2100
2101 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2102 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2103
2104 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2105 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2106
2107 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2108 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2109 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2110 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2111 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2112 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2113
2114 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2115 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2116 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2117 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2118 context.
2119
2120 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2121 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2122 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2123 happen when macros are involved.
2124
2125 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2126 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2127 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2128 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2129 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2130 line is left untouched.
2131
2132 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2133 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2134 syntactic indentation.
2135
2136 ---
2137 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2138
2139 ---
2140 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2141 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2142 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2143 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2144
2145 ** Fortran mode changes:
2146
2147 ---
2148 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2149 highlighting for the old default.
2150
2151 +++
2152 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2153 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2154 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2155
2156 +++
2157 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2158 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2159 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2160 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2161
2162 ---
2163 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2164 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2165 majority.
2166
2167 ---
2168 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2169 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2170
2171 ---
2172 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2173 to support use of font-lock.
2174
2175 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2176
2177 ---
2178 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2179 automatically.
2180
2181 +++
2182 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2183 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2184 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2185 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2186 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2187 from the file name or buffer contents.
2188
2189 +++
2190 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2191
2192 ** TeX modes:
2193
2194 +++
2195 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2196
2197 +++
2198 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2199 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2200 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2201 TeX commands to use at startup.
2202
2203 ---
2204 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2205 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2206
2207 +++
2208 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2209
2210 ** BibTeX mode:
2211
2212 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2213 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2214
2215 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2216 an existing BibTeX entry.
2217
2218 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2219
2220 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2221 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2222 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2223 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2224 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2225 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2226
2227 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2228 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2229
2230 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2231 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2232
2233 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2234 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2235
2236 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2237 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2238
2239 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2240 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2241 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2242
2243 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2244 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2245
2246 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2247 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2248
2249 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2250 in multiple BibTeX files.
2251
2252 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2253 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2254
2255 +++
2256 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2257 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2258 and `C-c C-r'.
2259
2260 ** GUD changes:
2261
2262 +++
2263 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2264 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2265
2266 ---
2267 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2268 and other common debugger commands.
2269
2270 +++
2271 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2272 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2273 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2274 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2275 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2276 Emacs 21/22 such as the the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2277 breakpoints.
2278
2279 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2280
2281 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2282 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2283 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2284
2285 +++
2286 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2287 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2288 not executing.
2289
2290 ---
2291 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2292
2293 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2294 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2295 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2296 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2297 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2298
2299 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2300 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2301 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2302 (gud-finish).
2303
2304 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2305 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2306
2307 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2308 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2309 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2310
2311 Added Customization Variables
2312
2313 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2314
2315 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2316 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2317 java sources (previous method).
2318
2319 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2320 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2321 is nil).
2322
2323 Minor Improvements
2324
2325 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2326 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2327 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2328 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2329 `starttls' tool).
2330
2331 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2332
2333 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2334
2335 +++
2336 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2337
2338 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2339 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2340 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2341 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2342 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2343 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2344 be mode dependent.
2345
2346 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2347 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2348 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2349 toggles this mode.
2350
2351 +++
2352 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2353 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2354 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2355 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2356 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2357 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2358 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2359 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2360 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2361
2362 +++
2363 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2364 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2365 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2366 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2367 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2368
2369 ---
2370 ** recentf changes.
2371
2372 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2373 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2374 automatic cleanup.
2375
2376 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2377 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2378 keep in the recent list.
2379
2380 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
2381 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
2382 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
2383 recent list with different symbolic links.
2384
2385 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2386 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2387 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2388
2389 +++
2390 ** Desktop package
2391
2392 +++
2393 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2394
2395 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2396
2397 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2398
2399 ---
2400 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2401 buffer list.
2402
2403 +++
2404 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2405 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2406 idle).
2407
2408 +++
2409 *** New commands:
2410 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2411 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2412 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2413 it was loaded.
2414 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2415 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2416
2417 ---
2418 *** New customizable variables:
2419 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2420 killed.
2421 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2422 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2423 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2424 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2425 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2426 should not delete.
2427 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2428 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2429 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2430 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2431
2432 +++
2433 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2434
2435 ---
2436 *** New hooks:
2437 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2438 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2439
2440 ---
2441 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2442
2443 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2444 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2445 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2446 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2447 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2448 feature.
2449
2450 ** EDiff changes.
2451
2452 +++
2453 *** When comparing directories.
2454 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2455 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2456 from one directory to another.
2457
2458 +++
2459 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2460 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2461 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2462 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2463 comparison.
2464
2465 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2466 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2467 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2468
2469 +++
2470 ** Etags changes.
2471
2472 *** New regular expressions features
2473
2474 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2475
2476 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2477 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2478 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2479 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2480 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2481 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2482 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2483 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2484 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2485 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2486
2487 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2488
2489 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2490 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2491 CR, TAB, VT,
2492
2493 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2494
2495 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2496 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2497 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2498
2499 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2500
2501 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2502 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2503
2504 *** New language parsing features
2505
2506 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2507
2508 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2509
2510 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
2511
2512 **** New language HTML.
2513
2514 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2515 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2516
2517 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2518
2519 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2520 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2521
2522 **** New language Lua.
2523
2524 All functions are tagged.
2525
2526 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2527
2528 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2529 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2530 package::sub.
2531
2532 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2533
2534 **** New language PHP.
2535
2536 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2537 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2538
2539 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2540
2541 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2542 renewenvironment.
2543
2544 *** Honour #line directives.
2545
2546 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2547 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2548 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2549 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2550 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2551
2552 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2553
2554 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2555 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2556 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2557 the file FILE.
2558
2559 ** VC Changes
2560
2561 +++
2562 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2563 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2564
2565 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2566 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2567 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2568 `.emacs' file:
2569
2570 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2571
2572 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2573
2574 +++
2575 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2576 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2577
2578 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2579 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2580 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2581
2582 +++
2583 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2584
2585 +++
2586 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2587
2588 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2589 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2590 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2591
2592 P: annotates the previous revision
2593 N: annotates the next revision
2594 J: annotates the revision at line
2595 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2596 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2597 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2598 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2599
2600 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2601
2602 +++
2603 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2604 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2605 in the repository.
2606
2607 +++
2608 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2609 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2610 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2611 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2612
2613 +++
2614 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2615 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2616 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2617
2618 +++
2619 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2620
2621 See the documentation of the user option
2622 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2623
2624 ** Rmail changes:
2625
2626 ---
2627 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2628
2629 +++
2630 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2631
2632 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2633 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2634 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2635 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2636 used instead of the native one.
2637
2638 ** Gnus package
2639
2640 ---
2641 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2642
2643 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2644 PGP/MIME.
2645
2646 ---
2647 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2648
2649 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2650
2651 ---
2652 ** MH-E changes.
2653
2654 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
2655 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2656
2657 ** Calendar changes:
2658
2659 +++
2660 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2661 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2662
2663 +++
2664 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2665 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2666 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2667 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2668 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2669 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2670 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2671 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2672 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2673
2674 +++
2675 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2676 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2677 count backward from the end of the year.
2678
2679 +++
2680 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2681 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2682 day of that ISO week.
2683
2684 ---
2685 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2686 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2687
2688 ---
2689 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2690 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2691 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2692 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2693
2694 ---
2695 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2696 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2697 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2698
2699 +++
2700 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
2701 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2702 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2703 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
2704
2705 +++
2706 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2707 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2708 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2709 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2710 formats.
2711
2712 ---
2713 ** sql changes.
2714
2715 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2716 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2717 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2718 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2719 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2720
2721 The following values are supported:
2722
2723 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2724 db2 DB2
2725 informix Informix
2726 ingres Ingres
2727 interbase Interbase
2728 linter Linter
2729 ms Microsoft
2730 mysql MySQL
2731 oracle Oracle
2732 postgres Postgres
2733 solid Solid
2734 sqlite SQLite
2735 sybase Sybase
2736
2737 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2738 SQL mode indicator.
2739
2740 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2741 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2742 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2743
2744 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2745
2746 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2747 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2748 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2749 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2750
2751 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2752 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2753
2754 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
2755
2756 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2757 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
2758
2759 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2760
2761 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2762 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2763 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2764 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2765 terminated.
2766
2767 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2768 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
2769 credentials to authenticate the user.
2770
2771 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
2772 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2773 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
2774
2775 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
2776 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
2777
2778 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2779 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2780 defaults.
2781
2782 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2783 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
2784 `sql-product'.
2785
2786 ---
2787 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
2788
2789 ** FFAP changes:
2790
2791 +++
2792 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
2793
2794 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2795 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2796 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2797 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
2798
2799 ---
2800 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
2801
2802 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
2803 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
2804
2805 ---
2806 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
2807
2808 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
2809 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
2810 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
2811 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
2812 with other details of skeleton construction.
2813
2814 ---
2815 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2816 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2817 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2818 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2819
2820 +++
2821 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2822 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2823 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
2824
2825 ---
2826 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
2827
2828 ---
2829 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2830 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2831 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
2832 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
2833
2834 ---
2835 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
2836
2837 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2838 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
2839 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
2840
2841 ---
2842 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2843 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2844 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2845 using strokes as an input method.
2846
2847 ** Emacs server changes:
2848
2849 +++
2850 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
2851
2852 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
2853 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
2854 % emacsclient -s foo file1
2855 % emacsclient -s bar file2
2856
2857 +++
2858 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
2859 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
2860 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
2861
2862 +++
2863 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
2864
2865 ---
2866 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
2867
2868 +++
2869 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2870
2871 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2872 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
2873 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
2874
2875 ---
2876 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
2877 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
2878
2879 ---
2880 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2881
2882 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
2883 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
2884 inverse-video.
2885
2886 ---
2887 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
2888
2889 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
2890 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
2891 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
2892
2893 ---
2894 ** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
2895
2896 ---
2897 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
2898
2899 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
2900 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
2901 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
2902 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
2903
2904 ---
2905 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
2906
2907 ---
2908 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
2909
2910 ---
2911 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
2912 \f
2913 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
2914
2915 +++
2916 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
2917
2918 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
2919 existing values. For example:
2920
2921 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
2922
2923 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
2924 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
2925
2926 ---
2927 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2928
2929 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2930 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2931
2932 ---
2933 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2934
2935 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2936
2937 ---
2938 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2939
2940 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2941 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2942 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2943 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2944 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
2945 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
2946
2947 ---
2948 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2949
2950 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2951 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2952 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2953 sound support for those formats.
2954
2955 ---
2956 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2957
2958 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2959
2960 ---
2961 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2962
2963 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2964 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2965 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2966
2967 ---
2968 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2969
2970 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2971 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2972 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2973 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2974 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2975 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2976 you wish to use them in other faces.
2977
2978 ---
2979 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2980
2981 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2982 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2983 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2984 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2985 any customizations.
2986
2987 ---
2988 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
2989
2990 ---
2991 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
2992 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
2993 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
2994 \f
2995 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2996
2997 ---
2998 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
2999 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3000
3001 +++
3002 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3003 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3004 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3005 `undefined'.)
3006
3007 +++
3008 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3009 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3010 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3011
3012 ---
3013 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3014 \f
3015 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3016
3017 ** General Lisp changes:
3018
3019 +++
3020 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3021
3022 +++
3023 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3024
3025 +++
3026 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3027
3028 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3029 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3030 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3031
3032 +++
3033 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3034
3035 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3036
3037 +++
3038 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3039
3040 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3041 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3042 first one.
3043
3044 +++
3045 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3046
3047 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3048 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3049
3050 +++
3051 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3052
3053 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3054 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3055 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3056 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3057
3058 +++
3059 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3060
3061 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3062
3063 +++
3064 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3065
3066 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3067 longer accepted.
3068
3069 +++
3070 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3071
3072 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3073 cyclic.
3074
3075 +++
3076 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3077
3078 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3079 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3080
3081 +++
3082 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3083
3084 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3085 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3086 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3087
3088 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3089 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3090
3091 +++
3092 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3093
3094 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3095 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3096 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3097
3098 +++
3099 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3100
3101 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3102 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3103 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3104
3105 +++
3106 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3107
3108 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3109 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3110 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3111 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3112
3113 +++
3114 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3115
3116 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3117 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3118 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3119
3120 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3121 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3122
3123 +++
3124 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3125
3126 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3127
3128 +++
3129 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3130
3131 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3132 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3133 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3134
3135 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3136
3137 +++
3138 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3139
3140 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3141 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3142
3143 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3144
3145 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3146 possible declaration specifiers are:
3147
3148 (indent INDENT)
3149 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3150
3151 (edebug DEBUG)
3152 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3153 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3154 but this is cleaner.)
3155
3156 ---
3157 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3158
3159 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3160
3161 ---
3162 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3163
3164 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3165 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3166 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3167 forms.
3168
3169 +++
3170 ** Variable aliases:
3171
3172 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3173
3174 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3175 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3176 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3177 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3178
3179 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3180 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3181
3182 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3183
3184 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3185 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3186 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3187
3188 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3189 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3190
3191 +++
3192 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3193 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3194
3195 ** defcustom changes:
3196
3197 +++
3198 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3199
3200 ** String changes:
3201
3202 +++
3203 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3204
3205 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3206 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3207 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3208
3209 +++
3210 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3211
3212 +++
3213 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3214
3215 +++
3216 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3217 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3218 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3219 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3220 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3221
3222 +++
3223 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3224 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3225
3226 +++
3227 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3228 text properties.
3229
3230 +++
3231 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3232 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3233 been declared obsolete.
3234
3235 +++
3236 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3237
3238 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3239 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3240 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3241 warnings in a separate window.
3242
3243 +++
3244 ** Progress reporters.
3245
3246 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3247 progress messages for the user.
3248
3249 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3250 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3251 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3252
3253 ** Buffer positions:
3254
3255 +++
3256 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3257 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3258 the usable window height and width is used.
3259
3260 +++
3261 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3262 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3263 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3264 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3265 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3266
3267 +++
3268 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3269
3270 It defaults to 1.
3271
3272 +++
3273 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3274
3275 It defaults to 1.
3276
3277 +++
3278 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3279
3280 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3281 functionality.
3282
3283 +++
3284 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3285
3286 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3287
3288 +++
3289 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3290
3291 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3292 give up and return LIMIT.
3293
3294 +++
3295 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3296 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3297 arg is non-nil.
3298
3299 +++
3300 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3301 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3302 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3303
3304 ** Text modification:
3305
3306 +++
3307 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3308 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3309 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3310
3311 +++
3312 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3313 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3314 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3315
3316 +++
3317 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3318 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3319 inserted substring.
3320
3321 +++
3322 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3323 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3324 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3325 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3326 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3327
3328 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3329 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3330 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3331 text.
3332
3333 +++
3334 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3335 argument.
3336
3337 +++
3338 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3339 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3340 be inserted is translated through it.
3341
3342 ---
3343 *** Text clones.
3344
3345 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3346 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3347 clone to the other.
3348
3349 ---
3350 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3351
3352 +++
3353 ** Atomic change groups.
3354
3355 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3356 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3357 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3358
3359 (atomic-change-group
3360 (insert foo)
3361 (delete-region x y))
3362
3363 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3364 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3365 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3366 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3367
3368 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3369 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3370
3371 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3372 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3373 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3374 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3375
3376 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3377 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3378 do this.
3379
3380 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3381 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3382 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3383 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3384
3385 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3386 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3387 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3388 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3389 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3390 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3391 twice.
3392
3393 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3394 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3395 returned values, like this:
3396
3397 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3398 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3399
3400 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3401 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3402 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3403
3404 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3405 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3406 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3407 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3408 finished.
3409
3410 ** Buffer-related changes:
3411
3412 ---
3413 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3414
3415 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3416
3417 +++
3418 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3419
3420 +++
3421 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3422 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3423 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3424 value of VARIABLE instead.
3425
3426 ** Local variables lists:
3427
3428 +++
3429 *** Text properties in local variables.
3430
3431 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3432 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3433
3434 +++
3435 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3436 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3437 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3438 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3439 needed.
3440
3441 ---
3442 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3443 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3444 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3445 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3446 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3447 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3448
3449 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3450 confirmation as before.
3451
3452 ** Searching and matching changes:
3453
3454 +++
3455 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3456 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3457 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3458
3459 +++
3460 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3461 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3462 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3463 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3464
3465 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3466 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3467
3468 +++
3469 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3470
3471 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3472 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3473 specified by the syntax table.
3474
3475 ---
3476 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3477
3478 +++
3479 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3480 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3481 characters and ranges.
3482
3483 ---
3484 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3485 properties from surrounding text.
3486
3487 +++
3488 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3489 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3490 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3491
3492 +++
3493 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3494 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3495 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3496
3497 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3498 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3499 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3500 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3501 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3502
3503 ** Undo changes:
3504
3505 +++
3506 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3507
3508 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3509 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3510 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3511
3512 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3513 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3514 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3515
3516 +++
3517 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3518 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3519 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3520
3521 +++
3522 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3523 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3524
3525 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3526 elements with the following format:
3527 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3528
3529 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3530 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3531 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3532 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3533
3534 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3535 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3536 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3537 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3538 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3539 rectangle.
3540 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3541 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3542 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3543 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3544 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3545 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3546 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3547 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3548
3549 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
3550 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
3551 the killed text.
3552
3553 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3554 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
3555 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
3556 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3557 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
3558
3559 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3560 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3561 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3562 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3563
3564 ** Syntax table changes:
3565
3566 +++
3567 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
3568
3569 +++
3570 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3571 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3572 of text properties as well as the character code.
3573
3574 +++
3575 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3576 by `syntax-after').
3577
3578 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
3579 current syntactic context at point.
3580
3581 ** File operation changes:
3582
3583 +++
3584 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3585 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
3586
3587 +++
3588 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3589 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3590 operation.
3591
3592 +++
3593 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3594 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3595 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3596 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3597
3598 +++
3599 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
3600 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
3601
3602 +++
3603 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3604 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3605 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3606
3607 +++
3608 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3609
3610 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3611
3612 +++
3613 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3614 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3615
3616 +++
3617 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3618 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3619 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3620 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3621
3622 +++
3623 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3624 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3625 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3626 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3627
3628 +++
3629 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
3630 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
3631 it's modified).
3632
3633 +++
3634 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3635 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3636 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3637 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3638 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3639 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3640 further filter candidate files.
3641
3642 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3643 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3644 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3645
3646 ---
3647 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
3648
3649 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
3650 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
3651 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
3652 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
3653 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3654
3655 +++
3656 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3657
3658 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3659 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3660 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3661 operations.
3662
3663 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3664 autoloaded when not really necessary.
3665
3666 ** Input changes:
3667
3668 +++
3669 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
3670 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
3671 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
3672
3673 +++
3674 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
3675 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
3676 it returns just the directory name.
3677
3678 ---
3679 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
3680 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3681 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3682
3683 +++
3684 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
3685 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
3686 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
3687 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
3688
3689 ** Minibuffer changes:
3690
3691 +++
3692 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
3693 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
3694 defaults to the current buffer.
3695
3696 +++
3697 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
3698 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
3699
3700 +++
3701 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
3702 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
3703
3704 +++
3705 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3706 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3707 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3708 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3709 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3710
3711 ---
3712 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
3713 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
3714
3715 +++
3716 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3717 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3718 `read-file-name' function.
3719
3720 +++
3721 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
3722
3723 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
3724 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
3725
3726 ** Completion changes:
3727
3728 +++
3729 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
3730 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3731 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3732 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
3733 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3734
3735 +++
3736 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
3737 as a dynamic completion table.
3738
3739 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3740
3741 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3742 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3743 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3744 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3745 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3746 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
3747
3748 +++
3749 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
3750 as a lazy completion table.
3751
3752 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3753
3754 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3755 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3756 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3757 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3758 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3759 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3760
3761 +++
3762 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
3763
3764 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
3765
3766 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
3767 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
3768 example,
3769
3770 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
3771
3772 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3773
3774 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
3775 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3776 binding and lookup functionality.
3777
3778 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3779 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3780 original command.
3781
3782 Example:
3783 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
3784 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
3785 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
3786 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
3787 `kill-word'.
3788
3789 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3790 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
3791 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
3792
3793 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3794 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3795
3796 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
3797 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
3798
3799 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
3800 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
3801 runs `my-kill-line'.
3802
3803 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3804
3805 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3806 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3807 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3808 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3809
3810 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3811 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3812
3813 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3814 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3815
3816 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3817 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3818 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3819 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3820 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
3821 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
3822
3823 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3824 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3825 command was not remapped.
3826
3827 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3828 over minor mode keymaps.
3829
3830 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3831 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3832 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3833
3834 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3835
3836 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3837 bindings of the parent keymap.
3838
3839 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3840
3841 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3842 active keymaps.
3843
3844 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3845 defined keys and their definitions.
3846
3847 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
3848
3849 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3850 in the keymap.
3851
3852 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
3853
3854 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3855 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
3856 keymap alist to this list.
3857
3858 ** Abbrev changes:
3859
3860 +++
3861 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
3862
3863 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3864
3865 +++
3866 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
3867
3868 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
3869 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
3870 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
3871 specify this flag.
3872
3873 +++
3874 ** Enhancements to process support
3875
3876 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3877 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
3878
3879 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
3880
3881 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
3882 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
3883 functions.
3884
3885 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
3886 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3887
3888 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
3889 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
3890
3891 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
3892 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
3893 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
3894 entire property list of a process.
3895
3896 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
3897 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3898 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3899 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3900 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3901 speech synthesis.
3902
3903 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3904
3905 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3906 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3907 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
3908 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
3909 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3910 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3911 emacs tries to read it.
3912
3913 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
3914
3915 This executes a shell command command synchronously in a separate
3916 process.
3917
3918 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
3919 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
3920 `default-directory'.
3921
3922 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
3923 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
3924
3925 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
3926 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
3927 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3928
3929 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
3930 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3931
3932 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
3933 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3934
3935 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
3936 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3937 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3938 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
3939 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
3940
3941 +++
3942 ** Enhanced networking support.
3943
3944 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
3945 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3946 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
3947
3948 - A server is started using :server t arg.
3949 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
3950 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3951 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3952 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
3953 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3954 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3955 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
3956
3957 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3958 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3959
3960 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
3961
3962 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
3963
3964 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3965 and set the current address of the remote partner.
3966
3967 *** New function `format-network-address'.
3968
3969 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
3970 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3971 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3972 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3973 string for other formatting options.
3974
3975 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
3976
3977 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
3978 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
3979 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
3980
3981 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
3982 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
3983
3984 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
3985
3986 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
3987 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
3988 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
3989 stopped state.
3990
3991 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
3992
3993 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3994 current network addresses.
3995
3996 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
3997
3998 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3999 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4000
4001 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4002
4003 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4004 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4005 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4006 "connection broken by remote peer".
4007
4008 ** Using window objects:
4009
4010 +++
4011 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4012
4013 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4014 header line.
4015
4016 +++
4017 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4018
4019 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4020 or the header line.
4021
4022 +++
4023 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4024
4025 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4026 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4027 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4028 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4029 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4030
4031 +++
4032 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4033 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4034 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4035 the mode line.
4036
4037 +++
4038 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4039 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4040
4041 +++
4042 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4043 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4044
4045 +++
4046 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4047
4048 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4049
4050 +++
4051 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4052 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4053 by calling `select-window'.
4054
4055 +++
4056 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4057
4058 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4059 and scroll-bar settings.
4060
4061 +++
4062 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4063
4064 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4065 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4066
4067 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4068 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4069
4070 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4071 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4072
4073 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4074 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4075 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4076 foreground color of the bitmap.
4077
4078 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4079 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4080 bitmap of the display line.
4081
4082 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4083 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4084 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4085 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4086 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4087
4088 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4089 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4090
4091 ** Other window fringe features:
4092
4093 +++
4094 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4095
4096 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4097 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4098 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4099 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4100
4101 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4102 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4103 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4104 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4105 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4106 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4107
4108 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4109 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4110 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4111 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4112
4113 +++
4114 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4115
4116 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4117 position settings.
4118
4119 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4120 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4121 `set-window-fringes'.
4122
4123 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4124 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4125 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4126 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4127
4128 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4129 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4130 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4131 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4132 an update of the display margins.
4133
4134 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4135 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4136
4137 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4138 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4139 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4140 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4141 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4142 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4143 of the display margins.
4144
4145 ** Redisplay features:
4146
4147 +++
4148 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4149
4150 +++
4151 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4152 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4153 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4154 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4155 forcing an explicit window update.
4156
4157 +++
4158 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4159 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4160 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4161
4162 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4163 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4164
4165 +++
4166 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4167 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4168
4169 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4170 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4171
4172 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4173 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4174 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4175 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4176 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4177 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4178
4179 +++
4180 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4181
4182 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4183 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4184
4185 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4186 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4187 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4188 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4189 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4190
4191 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4192 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4193 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4194
4195 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4196 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4197 the given value.
4198
4199 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4200 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4201 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4202
4203 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4204 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4205
4206 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4207 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4208 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4209 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4210 exactly that many pixels high.
4211
4212 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4213 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4214 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4215 the `line-spacing' variable.
4216
4217 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4218 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4219
4220 +++
4221 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4222 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4223
4224 +++
4225 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4226
4227 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4228 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4229 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4230
4231 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4232 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4233 are supported:
4234
4235 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4236 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4237 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4238 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4239 | scroll-bar | text
4240 POS ::= left | center | right
4241 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4242 OP ::= + | -
4243
4244 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4245 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4246 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4247 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4248 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4249 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4250 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4251 the image.
4252
4253 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4254 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4255 corresponding area of the window.
4256
4257 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4258 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4259 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4260 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4261 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4262 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4263 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4264 the width of the area.
4265
4266 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4267 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4268
4269 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4270 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4271 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4272
4273 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4274 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4275 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4276 height) of the specified image.
4277
4278 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4279 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4280
4281 +++
4282 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4283 text property string that may be present at the current window
4284 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4285 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4286
4287 +++
4288 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4289 supported on text terminals.
4290
4291 +++
4292 *** Support for displaying image slices
4293
4294 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4295 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4296
4297 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4298 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4299
4300 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4301 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4302
4303 +++
4304 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4305
4306 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4307 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4308 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4309 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4310 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4311 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4312 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4313 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4314
4315 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4316 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4317 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4318 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4319 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4320 for possible pointer shapes.
4321
4322 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4323 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4324 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4325
4326 ** Mouse pointer features:
4327
4328 +++ (lispref)
4329 ??? (man)
4330 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4331 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4332 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4333 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4334 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4335
4336 +++
4337 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4338 :pointer image property.
4339
4340 +++
4341 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4342 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4343
4344 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4345
4346 +++
4347 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4348 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4349
4350 +++
4351 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4352 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4353 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4354
4355 +++
4356 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4357
4358 +++
4359 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4360
4361 +++
4362 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4363 text area).
4364
4365 +++
4366 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4367 and all areas.
4368
4369 +++
4370 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4371 of the mouse event position.
4372
4373 +++
4374 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4375
4376 +++
4377 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4378 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4379
4380 +++
4381 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4382 (image or character) clicked on.
4383
4384 +++
4385 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4386
4387 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4388 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4389 the total width and height of that object.
4390
4391 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4392
4393 +++
4394 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4395 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4396
4397 +++
4398 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4399
4400 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4401 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4402 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4403 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4404
4405 +++
4406 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4407 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4408 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4409 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4410 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4411
4412 +++
4413 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4414
4415 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4416 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4417
4418 ** Face changes
4419
4420 +++
4421 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4422 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4423 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4424 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4425 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4426 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4427
4428 +++
4429 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4430 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4431
4432 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4433 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4434 defined with `defface'.
4435
4436 ---
4437 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4438 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4439 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4440 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4441 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4442
4443 +++
4444 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4445 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4446 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4447 by them).
4448
4449 +++
4450 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4451 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4452 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4453 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4454 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4455
4456 ---
4457 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4458 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4459 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4460
4461 +++
4462 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4463
4464 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4465 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4466 attribute.
4467
4468 +++
4469 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4470 help with handling relative face attributes.
4471
4472 +++
4473 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4474
4475 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4476 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4477 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4478 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4479 `face' properties.
4480
4481 ---
4482 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4483 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4484
4485 ** Font-Lock changes:
4486
4487 +++
4488 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4489
4490 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4491 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4492 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4493 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4494
4495 +++
4496 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4497
4498 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4499 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4500 properties than `face'.
4501
4502 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4503 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4504
4505 ---
4506 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4507
4508 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4509 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4510 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4511 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4512 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4513
4514 s{
4515 foo
4516 }{
4517 bar
4518 }e
4519
4520 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4521 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4522 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4523 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4524
4525 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
4526
4527 +++
4528 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4529 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4530 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4531 var `magic-mode-alist'.
4532
4533 +++
4534 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
4535
4536 +++
4537 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
4538 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
4539 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
4540
4541 ---
4542 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4543 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4544 it in that buffer.
4545
4546 +++
4547 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4548 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4549 the language.
4550
4551 +++
4552 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4553 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4554
4555 +++
4556 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4557 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4558 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4559
4560 ** Minor mode changes:
4561
4562 +++
4563 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4564 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
4565
4566 +++
4567 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
4568
4569 +++
4570 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
4571
4572 This is a new name for what was formerly called
4573 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
4574
4575 ** Command loop changes:
4576
4577 +++
4578 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4579 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
4580 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
4581
4582 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4583 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
4584
4585 +++
4586 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
4587
4588 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4589 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4590 macros.
4591
4592 +++
4593 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4594 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4595 covered by an image or composition property.
4596
4597 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4598 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4599 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4600 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4601 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4602
4603 +++
4604 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4605 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4606 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4607 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4608 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
4609
4610 +++
4611 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4612 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4613 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
4614
4615 +++
4616 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4617 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
4618
4619 ** Lisp file loading changes:
4620
4621 +++
4622 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4623 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4624 current file redefined it).
4625
4626 +++
4627 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4628 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4629
4630 +++
4631 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
4632 variable or face definitions.
4633
4634 +++
4635 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4636 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4637 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4638
4639 ---
4640 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4641 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4642 than 3 levels of nesting.
4643
4644 +++
4645 ** Byte compiler changes:
4646
4647 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
4648 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4649 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
4650 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
4651 compilation output buffer.
4652
4653 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4654 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4655
4656 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4657 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4658 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4659 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4660 forms:
4661
4662 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4663 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4664
4665 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4666 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4667 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4668 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4669 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
4670 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4671
4672 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4673 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4674 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
4675 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4676 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4677 you anything.
4678
4679 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
4680
4681 ---
4682 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4683 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4684 (require 'cl) when loaded.
4685
4686 ** Frame operations:
4687
4688 +++
4689 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
4690
4691 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4692 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
4693
4694 +++
4695 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4696 for all (existing and future) frames.
4697
4698 +++
4699 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4700 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4701 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4702 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4703
4704 +++
4705 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
4706 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
4707
4708 ** Mule changes:
4709
4710 +++
4711 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4712
4713 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4714 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4715 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4716 now:
4717
4718 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4719
4720 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4721 the time it takes to convert the format.
4722
4723 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4724 wasteful.
4725
4726 ---
4727 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
4728 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
4729
4730 +++
4731 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4732 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4733 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4734 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
4735
4736 ---
4737 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4738 of one coding system from another coding system.
4739
4740 ---
4741 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4742 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4743 parts, e.g. utf-16.
4744
4745 +++
4746 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4747 it is read from a file without decoding.
4748
4749 ---
4750 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4751 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
4752
4753 ---
4754 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
4755 current input method to input a character.
4756
4757 ** Mode line changes:
4758
4759 +++
4760 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
4761
4762 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
4763 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4764
4765 +++
4766 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4767 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4768
4769 +++
4770 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4771 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4772 line.
4773
4774 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
4775 `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
4776 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
4777 areas.
4778
4779 ** Menu manipulation changes:
4780
4781 ---
4782 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4783 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4784 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4785 several versions ago.
4786
4787 ---
4788 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
4789 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4790 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4791
4792 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4793 made with easy-menu.
4794
4795 ---
4796 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4797 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4798 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4799 need to have a name.
4800
4801 ** Operating system access:
4802
4803 +++
4804 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4805 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4806
4807 +++
4808 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4809 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4810 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4811
4812 +++
4813 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
4814
4815 ---
4816 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4817 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4818 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4819
4820 ---
4821 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4822 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4823
4824 ** Miscellaneous:
4825
4826 +++
4827 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
4828
4829 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
4830 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
4831 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
4832 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
4833 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
4834 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
4835 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
4836
4837 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
4838
4839 +++
4840 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
4841
4842 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
4843
4844 ---
4845 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
4846 running under X.
4847
4848 ** GC changes:
4849
4850 +++
4851 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
4852 on garbage collection.
4853
4854 +++
4855 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
4856
4857 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4858 \f
4859 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
4860
4861 +++
4862 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
4863 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
4864 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
4865 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
4866 such things as help and apropos buffers.
4867
4868 ---
4869 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
4870 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
4871 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
4872
4873 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4874 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4875 data structures.
4876
4877 ---
4878 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4879 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
4880
4881 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
4882 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
4883 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
4884 commands.
4885
4886 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
4887 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
4888 SQL buffer.
4889
4890 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
4891 (function (lambda ()
4892 (master-mode t)
4893 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4894 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
4895 (function (lambda ()
4896 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4897
4898 +++
4899 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
4900
4901 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
4902
4903 +++
4904 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
4905
4906 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
4907 code. It works with edebug.
4908
4909 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
4910 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
4911 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
4912 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
4913 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
4914
4915 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
4916 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
4917 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
4918 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
4919 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
4920 value, such as (setq x 14).
4921
4922 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
4923 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
4924 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
4925 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
4926 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
4927 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
4928 \f
4929 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4930
4931 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4932 been added.
4933
4934 \f
4935 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
4936
4937 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4938 with Custom.
4939
4940 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
4941 as mule-utf-8.
4942
4943 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4944 in UTF-8 locales).
4945
4946 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4947 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4948 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4949 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4950 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4951 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4952 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4953 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4954 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4955 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4956
4957 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4958 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4959
4960 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4961 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4962 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4963 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
4964 contrary to the compound text specification.
4965
4966 \f
4967 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4968
4969 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4970
4971 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4972
4973 \f
4974 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
4975
4976 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4977
4978 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4979 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4980 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4981 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4982 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4983
4984 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4985 were changed.
4986
4987 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4988 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4989
4990 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4991 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4992 instead of using default-major-mode.
4993
4994 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4995 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4996 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4997 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4998 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4999 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5000 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5001
5002 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5003 NEWS.
5004
5005 \f
5006 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5007
5008 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5009 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5010 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5011
5012 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5013 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5014
5015 \f
5016 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5017
5018 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5019 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5020 charsets in this release.
5021
5022 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5023
5024 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5025
5026 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5027 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5028 to list them.
5029
5030 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5031 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5032 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5033 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5034 necessary changes to unexec.
5035
5036 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5037 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5038
5039 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5040 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5041
5042 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5043 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5044
5045 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5046 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5047 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5048 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5049 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5050
5051 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5052 new display features described below.
5053
5054 \f
5055 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5056
5057 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5058
5059 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5060 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5061 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5062 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5063 the text.
5064
5065 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5066
5067 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5068 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5069 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5070 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5071 specify a font.
5072
5073 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5074 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5075 under Lisp changes, below.
5076
5077 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5078
5079 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5080 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5081 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5082 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5083 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5084 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5085 on terminals.
5086
5087 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5088 supported on character terminals.
5089
5090 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5091 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5092 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5093 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5094
5095 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5096
5097 ** Sound support
5098
5099 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5100 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5101 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5102 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5103 sound support.
5104
5105 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5106
5107 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5108 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5109 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5110 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5111
5112 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5113
5114 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5115 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5116 specifies a number of lines.
5117
5118 Default is 0.25.
5119
5120 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5121
5122 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5123 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5124 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5125 again.
5126
5127 Default is `grow-only'.
5128
5129 ** LessTif support.
5130
5131 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5132 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5133
5134 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5135
5136 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5137 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5138 non-nil.
5139
5140 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5141
5142 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5143 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5144 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5145
5146 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5147
5148 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5149 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5150 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5151 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5152 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5153 Emacs.
5154
5155 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5156 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5157 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5158 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5159 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5160 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5161
5162 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5163 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5164 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5165 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5166 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5167 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5168
5169 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5170 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5171 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5172 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5173 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5174
5175 ** Tool bar support.
5176
5177 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5178 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5179 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5180 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5181 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5182 icons will be used.
5183
5184 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5185 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5186
5187 ** Tooltips.
5188
5189 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5190 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5191 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5192
5193 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5194 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5195 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5196 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5197
5198 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5199
5200 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5201 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5202 customized.
5203
5204 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5205 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5206 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5207 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5208 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5209
5210 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5211 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5212 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5213 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5214 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5215 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5216
5217 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5218 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5219 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5220 customizing face `fringe'.
5221
5222 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5223 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5224 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5225 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5226 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5227 the window to be partially obscured.)
5228
5229 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5230 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5231 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5232 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5233
5234 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5235
5236 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5237 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5238 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5239 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5240 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5241 have enabled one.
5242
5243 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5244
5245 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5246
5247 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5248
5249 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5250 `*') toggles the status.
5251
5252 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5253
5254 ** Hourglass pointer
5255
5256 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5257 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5258
5259 ** Blinking cursor
5260
5261 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5262 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5263 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5264 the group `cursor'.
5265
5266 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5267
5268 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5269 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5270 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5271 details.
5272
5273 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5274 have to do anything to activate it.
5275
5276 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5277
5278 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5279 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5280
5281 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5282 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5283 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5284 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5285 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5286 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5287 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5288 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5289
5290 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5291 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5292 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5293 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5294 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5295 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5296
5297 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5298 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5299
5300 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5301 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5302 buffer by default.
5303
5304 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5305 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5306 beginning and end of the buffer.
5307
5308 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5309 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5310 signaled.
5311
5312 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5313 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5314
5315 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5316 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5317 this behavior.
5318
5319 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5320 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5321 Emacs dump core.
5322
5323 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5324
5325 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5326 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5327 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5328
5329 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5330 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5331 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5332
5333 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5334 using that menu.
5335
5336 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5337
5338 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5339 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5340 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5341 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5342 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5343 whitespace.
5344
5345 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5346 all frames except the selected one.
5347
5348 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5349 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5350
5351 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5352 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5353 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5354 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5355 `Info-use-header-line'.
5356
5357 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5358 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5359 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5360
5361 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5362
5363 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5364 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5365 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5366
5367 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5368 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5369 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5370 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5371
5372 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5373
5374 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5375 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5376 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5377 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5378
5379 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5380 point in a pop-up window.
5381
5382 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5383 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5384 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5385
5386 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5387 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5388
5389 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5390 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5391 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5392 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5393
5394 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5395
5396 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5397 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5398
5399 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5400 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5401 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5402
5403 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5404 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5405 non-nil.
5406
5407 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5408 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5409 file that is already visited under a different name.
5410
5411 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5412 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5413
5414 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5415 and displays information about that.
5416
5417 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5418 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5419
5420 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5421 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5422 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5423 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5424 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5425 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5426
5427 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5428 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5429
5430 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5431 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5432 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5433 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5434 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5435 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5436 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5437
5438 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5439 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5440
5441 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5442 system for keyboard input.
5443
5444 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5445 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5446 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5447 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5448 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5449 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5450 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5451 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5452 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5453
5454 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5455 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5456
5457 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5458 displays all characters in that character set.
5459
5460 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5461 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5462
5463 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5464 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5465 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5466
5467 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5468 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5469 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5470 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5471 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5472 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5473 and Polish `slash'.
5474
5475 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5476 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5477 of the tutorial.
5478
5479 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5480 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5481 Lisp Coding Convention".
5482
5483 new command old-binding
5484 --- ------- -----------
5485 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5486 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5487 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5488
5489 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5490 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5491 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5492
5493 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5494 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5495 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5496 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5497 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5498 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5499
5500 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5501 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5502 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5503 package.
5504
5505 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5506 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5507 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5508 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5509 "`", you must type "=q".
5510
5511 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5512 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5513 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5514 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5515 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5516 on.
5517
5518 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5519 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5520 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5521 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5522
5523 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5524 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5525 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5526 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5527
5528 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5529 on the display using several methods
5530
5531 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5532 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5533 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5534
5535 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5536 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5537
5538 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5539
5540 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5541 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5542
5543 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5544 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5545 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5546 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5547
5548 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5549 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5550 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5551
5552 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5553 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5554
5555 ** New X resources recognized
5556
5557 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5558 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5559 is useful for debugging X problems.
5560
5561 Example:
5562
5563 emacs.synchronous: true
5564
5565 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5566 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5567 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5568 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5569 visual class names are
5570
5571 TrueColor
5572 PseudoColor
5573 DirectColor
5574 StaticColor
5575 GrayScale
5576 StaticGray
5577
5578 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5579 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5580 meaning.
5581
5582 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5583 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5584 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5585 visual.
5586
5587 Example:
5588
5589 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5590
5591 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5592 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5593 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5594 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5595
5596 Example:
5597
5598 emacs.privateColormap: true
5599
5600 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5601
5602 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5603 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5604 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5605 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5606 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5607 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5608 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5609
5610 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5611 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5612 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5613 `default' face and vice versa.
5614
5615 ** New face `menu'.
5616
5617 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5618
5619 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5620
5621 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5622 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5623 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5624 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5625
5626 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5627 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5628 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5629
5630 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5631 `ScreenGamma'.
5632
5633 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5634
5635 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5636 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5637 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5638 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5639
5640 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5641
5642 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5643
5644 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5645
5646 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5647 LessTif/Motif one.
5648
5649 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5650 LessTif and Motif.
5651
5652 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5653
5654 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5655 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5656 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5657
5658 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5659 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5660
5661 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5662 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5663 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5664
5665 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5666
5667 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5668 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5669 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5670 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5671
5672 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5673 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5674 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5675 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5676
5677 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5678 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5679 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5680 buffers.
5681
5682 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5683
5684 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5685 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5686 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5687
5688 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5689 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5690 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5691 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5692 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5693 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5694
5695 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5696
5697 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5698 notably at the end of lines.
5699
5700 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5701 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5702
5703 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5704
5705 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5706 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5707
5708 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5709 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5710 after each match to get the replacement text.
5711
5712 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5713 you edit the replacement string.
5714
5715 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5716 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5717 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5718
5719 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5720
5721 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5722 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5723
5724 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5725 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5726 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5727 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5728
5729 --
5730 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5731 read mail from the menu etc.
5732
5733 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5734 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5735 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5736 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5737
5738 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5739 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5740
5741 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5742 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5743 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5744 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5745 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5746 of Emacs.
5747
5748 ** Customize changes
5749
5750 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5751 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5752 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5753 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5754 earlier versions of Emacs.
5755
5756 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5757 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5758 default).
5759
5760 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5761 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5762 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5763 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5764 file.
5765
5766 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5767 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5768 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5769 already in your init file.
5770
5771 ** New features in evaluation commands
5772
5773 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5774 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5775 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5776 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5777 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5778
5779 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5780 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5781 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5782 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5783 printed).
5784
5785 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5786 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5787
5788 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5789 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5790
5791 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5792 code when called with a prefix argument.
5793
5794 ** CC mode changes.
5795
5796 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5797 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5798 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5799 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5800 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5801 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5802 release.
5803
5804 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5805 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5806 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5807 confusion.
5808
5809 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5810 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5811 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5812 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5813
5814 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5815 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5816
5817 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5818 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5819
5820 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5821 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5822 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5823 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5824
5825 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5826 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5827 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5828 earlier statement. An example:
5829
5830 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5831 if (a[i])
5832 res += a[i]->offset;
5833 else
5834
5835 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5836 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5837 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5838 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5839 the preceding "if".
5840
5841 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5842 by default.
5843
5844 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5845 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5846 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5847 documentation or other natural language text.
5848
5849 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5850 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5851 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5852 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5853 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5854 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5855 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5856
5857 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5858 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5859 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5860 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5861
5862 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5863 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5864 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5865 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5866 Pike mode only.
5867
5868 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5869 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5870 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5871 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5872 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5873 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5874 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5875 is reported afterwards.
5876
5877 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5878 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5879 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5880
5881 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5882 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5883 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5884 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5885 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5886 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5887 groundwork.
5888
5889 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5890 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5891 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5892 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5893 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5894 have to bother.
5895
5896 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5897 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
5898 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
5899 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5900 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5901 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5902
5903 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5904 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5905 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5906 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5907 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5908 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5909 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5910 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5911
5912 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5913 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5914 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5915 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5916 above.
5917
5918 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5919 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5920 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5921 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5922 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5923 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5924 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5925 function documentation for more info.
5926
5927 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5928 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5929 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5930 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5931 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5932 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5933 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5934 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5935
5936 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5937
5938 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5939 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5940
5941 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5942 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5943 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5944 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5945 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5946 style system.
5947
5948 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5949 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5950 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5951 as far as possible.
5952
5953 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5954 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5955 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5956 chapter about this in the manual.
5957
5958 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5959 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5960 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5961 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5962 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5963
5964 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5965 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5966 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5967
5968 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5969 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5970
5971 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5972 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5973 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5974 inside CC Mode.
5975
5976 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5977 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5978 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5979 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5980 cc-mode/).
5981
5982 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5983 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5984 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5985 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5986 they were before the filling.
5987
5988 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5989 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5990 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5991 literals.
5992
5993 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5994 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5995 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5996 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5997 this function.
5998
5999 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6000 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6001 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6002 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6003 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6004
6005 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6006 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6007 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6008
6009 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6010
6011 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6012 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6013 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6014 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6015
6016 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6017 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6018 the column specified by comment-column.
6019
6020 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6021 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6022 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6023 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6024 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6025 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6026
6027 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6028 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6029 arguments.
6030
6031 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6032
6033 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6034 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6035 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6036 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6037 Provan).
6038
6039 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6040
6041 ** Dired changes
6042
6043 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6044 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6045 is, delete only empty directories.
6046
6047 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6048 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6049 copy directories recursively.
6050
6051 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6052 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6053 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6054
6055 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6056 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6057 directory.
6058
6059 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6060 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6061 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6062 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6063 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6064
6065 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6066 from ls switches.
6067
6068 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6069 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6070 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6071 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6072
6073 ** Gnus changes.
6074
6075 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6076 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6077 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6078
6079 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6080 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6081
6082 If you used procmail like in
6083
6084 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6085 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6086 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6087 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6088
6089 this now has changed to
6090
6091 (setq mail-sources
6092 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6093 :suffix ".in")))
6094
6095 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6096 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6097
6098 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6099 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6100 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6101 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6102
6103 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6104 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6105 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6106
6107 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6108 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6109 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6110 now just a compatibility layer.
6111
6112 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6113 Gnus facilities.
6114
6115 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6116 called to position point.
6117
6118 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6119 summary buffers and NOV files.
6120
6121 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6122 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6123
6124 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6125 subtly different manner.
6126
6127 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6128 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6129 ever-changing layouts.
6130
6131 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6132
6133 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6134
6135 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6136
6137 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6138 macros
6139
6140 Key binding Macro
6141 -------------------------
6142 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6143 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6144 C-c C-c u @uref
6145 C-c C-c q @quotation
6146 C-c C-c m @email
6147 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6148 M-RET @item
6149
6150 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6151
6152 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6153
6154 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6155 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6156 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6157
6158 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6159
6160 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6161 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6162 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6163 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6164 buffers to kill, as before.
6165
6166 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6167 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6168 this way.
6169
6170 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6171 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6172
6173 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6174
6175 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6176 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6177 use. Default is 1000.
6178
6179 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6180 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6181
6182 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6183
6184 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6185
6186 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6187 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6188 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6189 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6190
6191 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6192 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6193 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6194 the open block.
6195
6196 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6197 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6198 the normal block-hiding function.
6199
6200 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6201
6202 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6203 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6204 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6205 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6206
6207 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6208 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6209
6210 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6211
6212 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6213 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6214 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6215
6216 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6217 current buffer.
6218
6219 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6220 in a log file.
6221
6222 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6223 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6224 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6225 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6226 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6227 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6228
6229 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6230
6231 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6232
6233 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6234 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6235
6236 ** Changes in Font Lock
6237
6238 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6239 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6240
6241 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6242 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6243
6244 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6245 the face used for each string/comment.
6246
6247 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6248 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6249
6250 ** Changes to Shell mode
6251
6252 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6253 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6254 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6255 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6256
6257 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6258
6259 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6260 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6261
6262 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6263 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6264 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6265 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6266 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6267 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6268
6269 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6270 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6271 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6272 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6273 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6274 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6275 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6276 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6277
6278 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6279 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6280
6281 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6282 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6283 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6284
6285 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6286 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6287 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6288
6289 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6290 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6291 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6292
6293 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6294 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6295 argument, it appends to the file.
6296
6297 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6298 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6299 compatibility.
6300
6301 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6302 ring (history).
6303
6304 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6305 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6306 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6307
6308 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6309
6310 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6311 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6312 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6313 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6314 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6315 as correspondent.
6316
6317 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6318 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6319 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6320
6321 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6322 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6323 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6324 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6325 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6326
6327 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6328 like `j'.
6329
6330 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6331 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6332 digest message.
6333
6334 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6335 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6336
6337 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6338 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6339 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6340
6341 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6342 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6343
6344 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6345 use the -f option when sending mail.
6346
6347 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6348 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6349 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6350 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6351 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6352 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6353
6354 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6355 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6356 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6357
6358 ** Changes to TeX mode
6359
6360 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6361 `latex-mode'.
6362
6363 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6364
6365 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6366
6367 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6368
6369 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6370
6371 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6372 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6373 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6374 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6375 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6376 can be edited from that buffer.
6377
6378 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6379 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6380 `A' to use all marked entries).
6381
6382 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6383 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6384
6385 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6386 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6387 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6388 been cited.
6389
6390 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6391 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6392 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6393 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6394
6395 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6396 has the following new features:
6397
6398 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6399 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6400 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6401 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6402
6403 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6404 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6405 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6406 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6407 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6408 defaults to 1.
6409
6410 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6411 file names.
6412
6413 ** Ispell changes
6414
6415 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6416 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6417 spell-checks the current buffer.
6418
6419 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6420 added.
6421
6422 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6423 correction is made and re-checked.
6424
6425 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6426
6427 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6428 cases.
6429
6430 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6431 on syntax errors.
6432
6433 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6434 end of the buffer.
6435
6436 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6437
6438 ** Makefile mode changes
6439
6440 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6441
6442 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6443 Fontlock mode is active.
6444
6445 ** Isearch changes
6446
6447 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6448 so that searches can be resumed.
6449
6450 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6451 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6452 that started the search.
6453
6454 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6455 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6456
6457 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6458
6459 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6460 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6461 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6462 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6463 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6464 `secondary-selection'.
6465
6466 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6467 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6468 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6469 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6470 usual snappy response.
6471
6472 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6473 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6474 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6475 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6476
6477 ** VC Changes
6478
6479 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6480 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6481 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6482 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6483 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6484 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6485 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6486 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6487 file is registered in that backend.
6488
6489 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6490 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6491 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6492 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6493 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6494 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6495
6496 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6497 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6498 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6499 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6500 where it doesn't make sense.)
6501
6502 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6503 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6504 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6505
6506 *** General Changes
6507
6508 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6509 checks are always done now.
6510
6511 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6512 operations.
6513
6514 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6515 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6516 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6517
6518 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6519 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6520 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6521 the working file (``merge news'').
6522
6523 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6524 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6525 downwards.
6526
6527 *** Multiple Backends
6528
6529 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6530 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6531 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6532 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6533 local RCS archives.
6534
6535 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6536 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6537 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6538 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6539
6540 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6541 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6542 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6543 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6544 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6545
6546 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6547 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6548 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6549 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6550
6551 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6552 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6553 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6554 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6555
6556 *** Changes for CVS
6557
6558 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6559 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6560 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6561 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6562 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6563 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6564 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6565
6566 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6567 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6568 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6569 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6570 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6571 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6572 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6573 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6574 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6575 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6576 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6577 name.)
6578
6579 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6580 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6581 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6582 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6583 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6584 entire directory tree.
6585
6586 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6587 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6588 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6589 "watched" by other developers.)
6590
6591 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6592 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6593 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6594 starting at the given directory.
6595
6596 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6597
6598 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6599 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6600 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6601 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6602 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6603 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6604 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6605 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6606 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6607
6608 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6609 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6610 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6611 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6612
6613 ** New modes and packages
6614
6615 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6616 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6617 the default is not applicable.
6618
6619 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6620 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6621 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6622
6623 Features are:
6624
6625 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6626 drawn, like this: | \ /
6627 --+-- X
6628 | / \
6629
6630 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6631 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6632 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6633 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6634 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6635 you are drawing.
6636
6637 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6638 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6639
6640 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6641 flood-filling.
6642
6643 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6644 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6645 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6646 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6647
6648 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6649 also do without the mouse.
6650
6651 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6652 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6653 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6654 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6655 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6656
6657 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6658
6659 lines straight-lines
6660 rectangles squares
6661 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6662 ellipses circles
6663 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6664 spray-can setting size for spraying
6665 vaporize line vaporize lines
6666 erase characters erase rectangles
6667
6668 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6669 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6670 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6671 drawing.
6672
6673 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6674 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6675 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6676 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6677
6678 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6679 can be turned off).
6680
6681 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6682 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6683 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6684 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6685 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6686 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6687 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6688 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6689 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6690
6691 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6692 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6693 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6694 on certain projects.
6695
6696 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6697 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6698
6699 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6700
6701 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6702 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6703 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6704 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6705 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6706 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6707 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6708 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6709
6710 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6711 Emacs is idle.
6712
6713 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6714 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6715
6716 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6717 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6718
6719 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6720 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6721 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6722 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6723 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6724
6725 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6726 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6727 separate Texinfo file.
6728
6729 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6730 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6731 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6732 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6733 enter check-in log messages.
6734
6735 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6736 without invoking external programs.
6737
6738 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6739 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6740 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6741 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6742 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6743
6744 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6745 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6746
6747 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6748 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6749
6750 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6751 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6752 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6753 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6754 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6755 single step.
6756
6757 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6758 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6759 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6760 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6761
6762 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6763 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6764 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6765
6766 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6767 PostScript.
6768
6769 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6770
6771 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6772
6773 ; comment (until end of line)
6774 A non-terminal
6775 "C" terminal
6776 ?C? special
6777 $A default non-terminal
6778 $"C" default terminal
6779 $?C? default special
6780 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6781 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6782 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6783 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6784 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6785 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6786 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6787 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6788 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6789 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6790 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6791 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6792 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6793 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6794 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6795
6796 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6797
6798 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6799 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6800 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6801 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6802 equal signs of assignments.
6803
6804 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6805 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6806
6807 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6808 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6809 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6810
6811 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6812
6813 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6814 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6815 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6816 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6817 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6818 which answers different needs.
6819
6820 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6821 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6822 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6823 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6824 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6825 to be enabled.
6826
6827 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6828 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6829
6830 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6831
6832 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6833 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6834 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6835
6836 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6837
6838 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6839 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6840 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6841 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6842 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6843 and background colors.
6844
6845 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6846 Pascal) language.
6847
6848 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6849 the text at point.
6850
6851 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6852
6853 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6854
6855 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6856 whitespace in a file.
6857
6858 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6859 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6860 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6861 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6862 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6863 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6864 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6865
6866 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6867
6868 Here is an example of columns:
6869
6870 horse apple bus
6871 dog pineapple car EXTRA
6872 porcupine strawberry airplane
6873
6874 Doing the following settings:
6875
6876 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6877 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6878 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6879 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6880
6881
6882 Selecting the lines above and typing:
6883
6884 M-x delimit-columns-region
6885
6886 It results:
6887
6888 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
6889 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6890 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6891
6892 delim-col has the following options:
6893
6894 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6895 before all columns.
6896
6897 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6898 between each column.
6899
6900 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6901 after all columns.
6902
6903 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6904 each column.
6905
6906 delim-col has the following commands:
6907
6908 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6909 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6910
6911 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6912 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6913 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6914 recent file list can be displayed:
6915
6916 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
6917 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6918 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
6919
6920 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6921 dynamically change the menu appearance.
6922
6923 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6924 text.
6925
6926 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
6927 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6928 specific to Message mode.
6929
6930 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6931 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6932 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6933
6934 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6935 interface to access directory servers using different directory
6936 protocols. It has a separate manual.
6937
6938 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6939 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6940
6941 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6942
6943 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
6944 minibuffer with completion.
6945
6946 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6947 with the diary features.
6948
6949 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6950 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6951
6952 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6953 Fill mode.
6954
6955 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6956 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6957 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6958 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
6959
6960 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6961 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6962 `.g'.
6963
6964 ** Changes in sort.el
6965
6966 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6967 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6968 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6969 numeric base.
6970
6971 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
6972
6973 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6974 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6975 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6976
6977 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6978 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6979
6980 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6981 output ^M at the end of lines.
6982
6983 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6984 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6985
6986 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6987 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6988 `(msb-mode 1)'.
6989
6990 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6991 group.
6992
6993 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6994 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6995 are recognized:
6996
6997 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6998 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6999 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7000 nil -- just delete one character.
7001
7002 Default value is `untabify'.
7003
7004 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7005
7006 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7007 symbol, not double-quoted.
7008
7009 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7010 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7011 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7012 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7013
7014 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7015 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7016 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7017
7018 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7019 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7020 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7021
7022 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7023 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7024
7025 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7026 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7027
7028 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7029 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7030
7031 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7032 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7033 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7034 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7035 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7036 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7037
7038 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7039 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7040
7041 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7042
7043 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7044 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7045
7046 ** Shell script mode changes.
7047
7048 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7049 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7050 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7051
7052 ** Etags changes.
7053
7054 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7055
7056 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7057 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7058 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7059 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7060 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7061
7062 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7063 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7064
7065 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7066 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7067
7068 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7069 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7070 `template' keywords.
7071
7072 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7073 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7074
7075 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7076 types.
7077
7078 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7079
7080 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7081
7082 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7083 are now tagged.
7084
7085 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7086
7087 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7088 variables are tagged.
7089
7090 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7091
7092 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7093 for PSWrap.
7094
7095 ** Changes in etags.el
7096
7097 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7098 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7099 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7100
7101 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7102 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7103
7104 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7105 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7106 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7107 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7108
7109 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7110
7111 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7112 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7113
7114 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7115
7116 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7117 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7118 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7119
7120 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7121 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7122
7123 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7124 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7125
7126 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7127 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7128 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7129 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7130 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7131
7132 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7133 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7134 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7135
7136 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7137 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7138 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7139
7140 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7141 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7142 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7143
7144 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7145
7146 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7147
7148 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7149 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7150 expression from that list, are not checked.
7151
7152 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7153 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7154 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7155 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7156
7157 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7158
7159 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7160 displays local abbrevs, only.
7161
7162 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7163 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7164
7165 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7166 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7167 is measured in pixels.
7168
7169 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7170 to be visited as images.
7171
7172 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7173 were added to compile.el.
7174
7175 ** Withdrawn packages
7176
7177 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7178 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7179
7180 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7181
7182 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7183
7184 \f
7185 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7186
7187 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7188 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7189 See the sections below for details.
7190
7191 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7192 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7193 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7194 to remove the properties of the copy.
7195
7196 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7197 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7198 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7199 these properties are active.
7200
7201 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7202 ranges may affect some code.
7203
7204 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7205 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7206 make a difference to some code.
7207
7208 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7209 operates on the minibuffer.
7210
7211 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7212 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7213 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7214 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7215 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7216 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7217 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7218 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7219 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7220 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7221 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7222 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7223
7224 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7225 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7226 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7227
7228 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7229 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7230 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7231
7232 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7233 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7234 such as `mapconcat'.
7235
7236 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7237 string.
7238
7239 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7240 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7241 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7242 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7243 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7244 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7245 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7246 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7247
7248 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7249 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7250 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7251 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7252 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7253 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7254 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7255 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7256 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7257 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7258
7259 \f
7260 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7261 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7262
7263 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7264
7265 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7266 allows the animated display of strings.
7267
7268 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7269 interactive form of a function.
7270
7271 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7272 between custom options. Example:
7273
7274 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7275 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7276 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7277 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7278 :group 'mule
7279 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7280 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7281
7282 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7283 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7284 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7285
7286 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7287 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7288 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7289 (signal or normal termination).
7290
7291 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7292 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7293
7294 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7295 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7296
7297 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7298 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7299
7300 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7301
7302 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7303 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7304 being deleted.
7305
7306 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7307
7308 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7309 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7310 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7311 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7312 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7313 charset.
7314
7315 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7316 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7317 message.
7318
7319 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7320 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7321
7322 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7323 with the more general `:mask' property.
7324
7325 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7326
7327 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7328 backslash.
7329
7330 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7331 is running in batch mode. For example,
7332
7333 (message "%s" (read t))
7334
7335 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7336 to standard output.
7337
7338 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7339 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7340
7341 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7342 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7343 frame or window.
7344
7345 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7346 were added
7347
7348 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7349
7350 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7351 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7352
7353 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7354
7355 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7356 comparison is done with `eq'.
7357
7358 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7359
7360 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7361 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7362 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7363
7364 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7365 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7366 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7367
7368 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7369 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7370
7371 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7372 function was declared obsolete.
7373
7374 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7375 retained as an alias).
7376
7377 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7378 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7379
7380 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7381
7382 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7383
7384 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7385 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7386 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7387 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7388 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7389 means never include the minibuffer window.
7390
7391 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7392
7393 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7394
7395 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7396
7397 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7398 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7399 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7400 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7401 returned.
7402
7403 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7404 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7405 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7406 minibuffer even if it is active.
7407
7408 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7409 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7410 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7411 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7412 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7413 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7414
7415 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7416 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7417 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7418 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7419 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7420 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7421 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7422
7423 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7424 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7425 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7426
7427 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7428 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7429 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7430 Default value is nil.
7431
7432 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7433 meaning no limit.
7434
7435 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7436 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7437 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7438
7439 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7440 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7441 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7442
7443 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7444 list of a primitive.
7445
7446 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7447
7448 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7449 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7450 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7451 than replacing the local map.
7452
7453 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7454 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7455 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7456 instead.
7457
7458 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7459
7460 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7461 as promised long ago.
7462
7463 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7464
7465 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7466 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7467 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7468
7469 \f
7470 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7471
7472 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7473 regular expressions.
7474
7475 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7476
7477 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7478
7479 - Macro: rx SEXP
7480
7481 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7482
7483 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7484 notation.
7485
7486 STRING
7487 matches string STRING literally.
7488
7489 CHAR
7490 matches character CHAR literally.
7491
7492 `not-newline'
7493 matches any character except a newline.
7494 .
7495 `anything'
7496 matches any character
7497
7498 `(any SET)'
7499 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7500 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7501
7502 '(in SET)'
7503 like `any'.
7504
7505 `(not (any SET))'
7506 matches any character not in SET
7507
7508 `line-start'
7509 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7510 in the text being matched
7511
7512 `line-end'
7513 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7514
7515 `string-start'
7516 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7517 string being matched against.
7518
7519 `string-end'
7520 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7521 string being matched against.
7522
7523 `buffer-start'
7524 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7525 buffer being matched against.
7526
7527 `buffer-end'
7528 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7529 buffer being matched against.
7530
7531 `point'
7532 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7533
7534 `word-start'
7535 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7536 word.
7537
7538 `word-end'
7539 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7540
7541 `word-boundary'
7542 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7543 word.
7544
7545 `(not word-boundary)'
7546 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7547 word.
7548
7549 `digit'
7550 matches 0 through 9.
7551
7552 `control'
7553 matches ASCII control characters.
7554
7555 `hex-digit'
7556 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7557
7558 `blank'
7559 matches space and tab only.
7560
7561 `graphic'
7562 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7563 space, and DEL.
7564
7565 `printing'
7566 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7567 and DEL.
7568
7569 `alphanumeric'
7570 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7571 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7572
7573 `letter'
7574 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7575 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7576
7577 `ascii'
7578 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7579
7580 `nonascii'
7581 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7582
7583 `lower'
7584 matches anything lower-case.
7585
7586 `upper'
7587 matches anything upper-case.
7588
7589 `punctuation'
7590 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7591 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7592
7593 `space'
7594 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7595
7596 `word'
7597 matches anything that has word syntax.
7598
7599 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7600 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7601 of the following symbols.
7602
7603 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7604 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7605 `word' (\\sw)
7606 `symbol' (\\s_)
7607 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7608 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7609 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7610 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7611 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7612 `escape' (\\s\\)
7613 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7614 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7615 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7616
7617 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7618 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7619
7620 `(category CATEGORY)'
7621 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7622 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7623
7624 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7625 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7626 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7627 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7628 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7629 `symbol' (\\c5)
7630 `digit' (\\c6)
7631 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7632 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7633 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7634 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7635 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7636 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7637 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7638 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7639 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7640 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7641 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7642 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7643 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7644 `ascii' (\\ca)
7645 `arabic' (\\cb)
7646 `chinese' (\\cc)
7647 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7648 `greek' (\\cg)
7649 `korean' (\\ch)
7650 `indian' (\\ci)
7651 `japanese' (\\cj)
7652 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7653 `latin' (\\cl)
7654 `lao' (\\co)
7655 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7656 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7657 `thai' (\\ct)
7658 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7659 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7660 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7661 `can-break' (\\c|)
7662
7663 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7664 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7665
7666 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7667 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7668
7669 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7670 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7671 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7672
7673 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7674 another name for `submatch'.
7675
7676 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7677 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7678 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7679 regular expression.
7680
7681 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7682 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7683 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7684 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7685 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7686
7687 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7688 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7689
7690 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7691 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7692
7693 `(0+ SEXP)'
7694 like `zero-or-more'.
7695
7696 `(* SEXP)'
7697 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7698
7699 `(*? SEXP)'
7700 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7701
7702 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7703 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7704
7705 `(1+ SEXP)'
7706 like `one-or-more'.
7707
7708 `(+ SEXP)'
7709 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7710
7711 `(+? SEXP)'
7712 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7713
7714 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7715 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7716
7717 `(optional SEXP)'
7718 like `zero-or-one'.
7719
7720 `(? SEXP)'
7721 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7722
7723 `(?? SEXP)'
7724 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7725
7726 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7727 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7728
7729 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7730 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7731
7732 `(eval FORM)'
7733 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7734 `regexp-quote' it.
7735
7736 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7737 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7738
7739 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7740
7741 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7742 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7743 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7744 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7745
7746 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7747 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7748 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7749 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7750
7751 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7752 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7753 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7754
7755 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7756 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7757 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7758 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7759 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7760 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7761 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7762 eight-bit-graphic.
7763
7764 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7765
7766 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7767 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7768 character set as previously.
7769
7770 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7771 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7772 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7773
7774 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7775 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7776 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7777 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7778
7779 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7780 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7781
7782 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7783 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7784 "fontset-default".
7785
7786 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7787 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7788
7789 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7790 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7791 buffers and strings.
7792
7793 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7794 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7795 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7796 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7797 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7798 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7799 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7800 also been deleted.
7801
7802 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7803 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7804 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7805
7806 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7807 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7808 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7809 may differ between buffer and string text.
7810
7811 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7812 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7813
7814 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7815 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7816 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7817 `composition' from STRING.
7818
7819 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7820 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7821
7822 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7823 obsolete.
7824
7825 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7826 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7827
7828 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7829 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7830 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7831 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7832
7833 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7834 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7835 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7836 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7837 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7838 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7839
7840 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7841 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7842 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7843
7844 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7845 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7846 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7847
7848 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7849 have been introduced.
7850
7851 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7852 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7853 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7854 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7855 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7856 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7857 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7858 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7859 their multibyte equivalent.
7860
7861 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7862 that offset in the file before writing.
7863
7864 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7865 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7866
7867 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7868 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7869 from which the command was issued.
7870
7871 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7872 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7873 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7874 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7875 operate on.
7876
7877 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7878 to `window-buffer-height'.
7879
7880 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7881
7882 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7883 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7884 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7885
7886 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7887 respectively.
7888
7889 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
7890 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7891
7892 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7893 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7894 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7895
7896 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7897 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7898 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7899 is currently displayed in some window.
7900
7901 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7902 argument function's results.
7903
7904 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
7905 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
7906 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
7907 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
7908 sequence).
7909
7910 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
7911 header in the list of headers passed to it.
7912
7913 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7914 ignores differences in case and text representation.
7915
7916 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
7917 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7918 as follows:
7919
7920 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7921 nil don't display a cursor
7922 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7923 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7924 others display a box cursor.
7925
7926 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7927 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7928 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7929 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7930
7931 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
7932 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
7933 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7934 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7935
7936 Example:
7937
7938 (string-to-syntax "()")
7939 => (4 . 41)
7940
7941 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7942 other than 10.
7943
7944 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7945 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7946
7947 #b1111
7948 => 15
7949 #b-1111
7950 => -15
7951
7952 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7953
7954 #o666
7955 => 438
7956
7957 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7958
7959 #xbeef
7960 => 48815
7961
7962 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7963
7964 #2R-111
7965 => -7
7966 #25rah
7967 => 267
7968
7969 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
7970 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
7971 and isn't a string.
7972
7973 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7974 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7975 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7976 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7977
7978 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7979
7980 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
7981 for a regexp in a string.
7982
7983 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7984 `mouse-position-function'.
7985
7986 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7987 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7988
7989 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7990 Keywords are now always considered constants.
7991
7992 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7993 returns it.
7994
7995 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7996 returned by function `recent-keys'.
7997
7998 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7999 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8000 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8001 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8002 mode.
8003
8004 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8005 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8006
8007 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8008 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8009 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8010 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8011 been performed."
8012
8013 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8014 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8015 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8016 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8017
8018 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8019 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8020 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8021
8022 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8023 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8024 specified table.
8025
8026 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8027
8028 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8029 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8030 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8031 what BODY returns.
8032
8033 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8034 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8035 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8036 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8037 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8038
8039 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8040 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8041
8042 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8043 instead of being optional.
8044
8045 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8046 modify read-only text.
8047
8048 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8049
8050 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8051 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8052 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8053 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8054 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8055
8056 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8057 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8058 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8059 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8060 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8061 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8062 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8063
8064 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8065 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8066 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8067 start sequences.
8068
8069 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8070 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8071
8072 ** New function `propertize'
8073
8074 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8075 strings with text properties.
8076
8077 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8078
8079 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8080 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8081 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8082 specified value of that property. Example:
8083
8084 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8085
8086 ** push and pop macros.
8087
8088 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8089 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8090 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8091
8092 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8093 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8094 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8095
8096 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8097
8098 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8099 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8100
8101 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8102 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8103 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8104 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8105
8106 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8107 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8108 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8109 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8110
8111 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8112 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8113 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8114 or a sign.
8115
8116 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8117 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8118 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8119 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8120 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8121 space, and DEL.
8122 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8123 and DEL.
8124 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8125 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8126 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8127 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8128 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8129 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8130 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8131 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8132 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8133 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8134 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8135 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8136 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8137 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8138 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8139
8140 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8141
8142 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8143
8144 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8145
8146 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8147 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8148
8149 :test TEST
8150
8151 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8152 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8153 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8154
8155 :size SIZE
8156
8157 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8158 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8159
8160 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8161
8162 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8163 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8164 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8165 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8166 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8167
8168 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8169
8170 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8171 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8172 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8173
8174 :weakness WEAK
8175
8176 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8177 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8178 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8179 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8180 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8181
8182 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8183
8184 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8185
8186 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8187
8188 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8189
8190 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8191
8192 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8193 values are shared.
8194
8195 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8196
8197 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8198
8199 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8200
8201 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8202
8203 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8204
8205 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8206
8207 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8208
8209 Returns the size of TABLE.
8210
8211 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8212
8213 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8214
8215 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8216
8217 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8218
8219 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8220
8221 Clear TABLE.
8222
8223 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8224
8225 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8226 not found.
8227
8228 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8229
8230 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8231 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8232
8233 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8234
8235 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8236
8237 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8238
8239 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8240 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8241
8242 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8243
8244 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8245
8246 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8247
8248 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8249 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8250 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8251 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8252 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8253
8254 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8255
8256 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8257 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8258 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8259
8260 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8261 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8262
8263 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8264 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8265
8266 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8267 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8268
8269 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8270 'case-fold-string-hash))
8271
8272 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8273
8274 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8275
8276 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8277 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8278 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8279
8280 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8281
8282 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8283 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8284
8285 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8286 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8287 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8288 is too short to reach that column.
8289
8290 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8291 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8292 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8293 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8294
8295 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8296 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8297 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8298
8299 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8300 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8301
8302 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8303 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8304
8305 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8306 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8307 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8308 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8309 temporary-file-directory instead.
8310
8311 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8312 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8313 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8314 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8315
8316 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8317 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8318
8319 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8320
8321 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8322 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8323 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8324
8325 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8326
8327 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8328 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8329 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8330 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8331 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8332 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8333
8334 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8335 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8336 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8337 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8338
8339 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8340
8341 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8342 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8343 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8344 result string.
8345
8346 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8347 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8348
8349 Example:
8350
8351 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8352 (s2 "world"))
8353 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8354 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8355 (format s1 s2))
8356
8357 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8358
8359 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8360
8361 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8362 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8363 argument in it.
8364
8365 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8366 (arg "world"))
8367 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8368 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8369 (message msg arg))
8370
8371 ** Sound support
8372
8373 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8374 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8375
8376 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8377 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8378 to enable sound support.
8379
8380 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8381 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8382 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8383 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8384 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8385
8386 The following sound properties are supported:
8387
8388 - `:file FILE'
8389
8390 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8391 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8392
8393 - `:data DATA'
8394
8395 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8396 may be present, but not both.
8397
8398 - `:volume VOLUME'
8399
8400 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8401 0..1. This property is optional.
8402
8403 - `:device DEVICE'
8404
8405 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8406 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8407
8408 Other properties are ignored.
8409
8410 An alternative interface is called as
8411 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8412
8413 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8414
8415 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8416 a keyword symbol.
8417
8418 ** Changes to garbage collection
8419
8420 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8421 of live and free strings.
8422
8423 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8424 strings that have been consed so far.
8425
8426 \f
8427 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8428 Lisp Manual
8429
8430 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8431 mini-windows.
8432
8433 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8434 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8435 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8436
8437 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8438
8439 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8440
8441 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8442 image.
8443
8444 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8445
8446 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8447
8448 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8449 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8450 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8451 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8452 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8453
8454 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8455 has a mask bitmap.
8456
8457 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8458
8459 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8460 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8461 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8462
8463 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8464 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8465
8466 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8467 optional.
8468
8469 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8470 below).
8471
8472 \f
8473 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8474
8475 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8476 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8477
8478 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8479 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8480 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8481 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8482 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8483 just display it black instead.
8484
8485 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8486 a line like
8487
8488 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8489
8490 in your `.emacs'.
8491
8492 ** New face implementation.
8493
8494 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8495 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8496
8497 *** New faces.
8498
8499 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8500
8501 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8502
8503 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8504 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8505
8506 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8507
8508 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8509
8510 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8511
8512 6. Foreground color.
8513
8514 7. Background color.
8515
8516 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8517
8518 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8519
8520 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8521
8522 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8523
8524 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8525 color.
8526
8527 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8528 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8529
8530 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8531 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8532 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8533 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8534 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8535 attributes mentioned above.
8536
8537 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8538 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8539 created frames.
8540
8541 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8542 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8543 `fully-specified'.
8544
8545 *** Face merging.
8546
8547 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8548 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8549 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8550 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8551 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8552 results in a fully-specified face.
8553
8554 *** Face realization.
8555
8556 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8557 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8558 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8559 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8560 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8561 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8562
8563 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8564 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8565 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8566 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8567
8568 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8569 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8570 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8571 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8572 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8573
8574 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8575 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8576 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8577 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8578 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8579 Emacs.
8580
8581 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8582 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8583 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8584 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8585
8586 **** Clearing face caches.
8587
8588 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8589 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8590 unused fonts.
8591
8592 *** Font selection.
8593
8594 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8595 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8596 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8597
8598 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8599 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8600 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8601 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8602 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8603
8604 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8605 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8606 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8607
8608 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8609
8610 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8611 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8612 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8613 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8614 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8615 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8616 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8617
8618 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8619 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8620 doesn't exist.
8621
8622 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8623 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8624 registry.
8625
8626 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8627 slightly different.
8628
8629 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8630
8631
8632 **** Scalable fonts
8633
8634 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8635 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8636 servers.
8637
8638 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8639 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8640 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8641 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8642 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8643 that list. Example:
8644
8645 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8646
8647 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8648
8649 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8650
8651 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8652
8653 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8654 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8655 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8656
8657 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8658 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8659 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8660 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8661 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8662 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8663 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8664 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8665 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8666 of the face font sort order.
8667
8668 - Function: x-font-family-list
8669
8670 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8671 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8672 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8673 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8674
8675 - Variable: font-list-limit
8676
8677 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8678 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8679 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8680
8681 *** Setting face attributes.
8682
8683 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8684 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8685 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8686 `face-attribute'.
8687
8688 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8689 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8690
8691 The following attributes are recognized:
8692
8693 `:family'
8694
8695 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8696 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8697 and `?' are allowed.
8698
8699 `:width'
8700
8701 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8702 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8703 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8704 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8705
8706 `:height'
8707
8708 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8709 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8710 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8711 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8712
8713 `:weight'
8714
8715 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8716 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8717 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8718
8719 `:slant'
8720
8721 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8722 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8723 `reverse-oblique'.
8724
8725 `:foreground', `:background'
8726
8727 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8728
8729 `:underline'
8730
8731 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8732 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8733 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8734 don't underline.
8735
8736 `:overline'
8737
8738 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8739 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8740 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8741 overline.
8742
8743 `:strike-through'
8744
8745 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8746 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8747 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8748 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8749
8750 `:box'
8751
8752 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8753 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8754 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8755 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8756 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8757 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8758 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8759 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8760 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8761 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8762 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8763 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8764 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8765 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8766 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8767 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8768 box.
8769
8770 `:inverse-video'
8771
8772 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8773 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8774
8775 `:stipple'
8776
8777 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8778 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8779 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8780 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8781 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8782 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8783
8784 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8785 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8786
8787 `:font'
8788
8789 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8790 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8791 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8792 versions of Emacs.
8793
8794 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8795 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8796 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8797
8798 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8799 `defface'.
8800
8801 `:inherit'
8802
8803 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8804 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8805 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8806
8807 *** Face attributes and X resources
8808
8809 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8810 from X resources:
8811
8812 Face attribute X resource class
8813 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8814 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8815 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8816 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8817 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8818 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8819 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8820 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8821 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8822 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8823 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8824 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8825 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8826 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8827 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8828 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8829 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8830 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8831 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8832 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8833
8834 *** Text property `face'.
8835
8836 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8837 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8838 specification can be
8839
8840 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8841
8842 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8843 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8844 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8845 for face attribute names.
8846
8847 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8848 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8849 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8850
8851 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8852
8853 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8854 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8855 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8856 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8857 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8858 used to clear the mapping table.
8859
8860 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8861
8862 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8863 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8864 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8865 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8866 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8867 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8868 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8869 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8870 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8871 modify their color-related behavior.
8872
8873 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8874 any frame type.
8875
8876 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8877
8878 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8879 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8880 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8881 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8882 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8883 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8884 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8885 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8886 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8887
8888 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8889 display can display image files.
8890
8891 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
8892
8893 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
8894 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8895 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8896 `Inviolable' option.
8897
8898 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
8899 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
8900 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
8901
8902 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8903
8904 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8905 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
8906 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
8907
8908 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
8909 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
8910 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
8911 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
8912 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8913 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8914 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8915 functions.
8916
8917 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
8918 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
8919 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
8920
8921 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8922
8923 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
8924
8925 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
8926
8927 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8928 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
8929 constrained position if that is different.
8930
8931 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8932 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8933 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
8934 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
8935 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8936 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
8937 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8938 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8939 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
8940
8941 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8942 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8943 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8944 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8945 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8946
8947 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8948 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8949
8950 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8951
8952 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
8953
8954 Delete the field surrounding POS.
8955 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8956 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8957
8958 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8959
8960 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8961 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8962 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8963 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
8964 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8965
8966 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8967
8968 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8969 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8970 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8971 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
8972 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8973
8974 - Function: field-string &optional POS
8975
8976 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8977 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8978 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8979
8980 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8981
8982 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8983 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8984 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8985
8986 ** Image support.
8987
8988 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8989 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8990 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8991 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8992
8993 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8994 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8995 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8996 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8997 area.
8998
8999 IMAGE is an image specification.
9000
9001 *** Image specifications
9002
9003 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9004 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9005 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9006 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9007 described below are ignored.
9008
9009 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9010
9011 `:ascent ASCENT'
9012
9013 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9014 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9015 to use for its ascent.
9016
9017 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9018 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9019
9020 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9021 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9022 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9023 overlays that apply to the image.
9024
9025 `:margin MARGIN'
9026
9027 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9028 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9029 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9030
9031 `:relief RELIEF'
9032
9033 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9034 around an image.
9035
9036 `:conversion ALGO'
9037
9038 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9039
9040 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9041 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9042
9043 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9044 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9045 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9046 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9047 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9048 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9049 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9050 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9051 below.
9052
9053 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9054 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9055 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9056
9057 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9058 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9059 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9060 of the factors' absolute values.
9061
9062 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9063
9064 (1 0 0
9065 0 0 0
9066 9 9 -1)
9067
9068 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9069
9070 ( 2 -1 0
9071 -1 0 1
9072 0 1 -2)
9073
9074 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9075 ``disabled''.
9076
9077 `:mask MASK'
9078
9079 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9080 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9081 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9082 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9083 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9084 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9085 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9086 image.
9087
9088 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9089 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9090 `:mask nil'.
9091
9092 `:file FILE'
9093
9094 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9095 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9096 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9097 may be present in the image specification.
9098
9099 `:data DATA'
9100
9101 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9102 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9103 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9104 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9105
9106 *** Supported image types
9107
9108 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9109
9110 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9111 properties supported are:
9112
9113 `:foreground FG'
9114
9115 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9116 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9117
9118 `:background BG'
9119
9120 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9121 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9122
9123 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9124 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9125 instead of a `:file' property.
9126
9127 `:width WIDTH'
9128
9129 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9130
9131 `:height HEIGHT'
9132
9133 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9134
9135 `:data DATA'
9136
9137 DATA must be either
9138
9139 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9140 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9141
9142 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9143
9144 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9145 bitmap.
9146
9147 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9148 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9149 in the file.
9150
9151 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9152
9153 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9154 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9155 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9156 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9157
9158 Additional image properties supported are:
9159
9160 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9161
9162 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9163 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9164 name.
9165
9166 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9167 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9168
9169 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9170 to display compressed images.
9171
9172 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9173
9174 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9175 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9176 mono images are:
9177
9178 `:foreground FG'
9179
9180 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9181 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9182
9183 `:background FG'
9184
9185 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9186 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9187
9188 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9189
9190 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9191 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9192 properties defined.
9193
9194 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9195
9196 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9197 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9198 properties defined.
9199
9200 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9201
9202 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9203 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9204
9205 Additional image properties supported are:
9206
9207 `:index INDEX'
9208
9209 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9210 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9211 as a hollow box.
9212
9213 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9214 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9215 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9216 every 0.1 seconds.
9217
9218 (defun show-anim (file max)
9219 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9220 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9221
9222 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9223 (when (= idx max)
9224 (setq idx 0))
9225 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9226 (save-excursion
9227 (set-buffer buffer)
9228 (goto-char (point-min))
9229 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9230 (insert-image img "x"))
9231 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9232
9233 **** PNG, image type `png'
9234
9235 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9236 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9237 properties defined.
9238
9239 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9240
9241 Additional image properties supported are:
9242
9243 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9244
9245 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9246 integer. This is a required property.
9247
9248 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9249
9250 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9251 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9252
9253 `:bounding-box BOX'
9254
9255 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9256 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9257 files. This is an required property.
9258
9259 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9260 lisp/gs.el.
9261
9262 *** Lisp interface.
9263
9264 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9265 which are supported in the current configuration.
9266
9267 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9268 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9269 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9270 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9271 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9272
9273 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9274
9275 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9276 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9277 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9278 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9279 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9280 buffer.
9281
9282 ** Display margins.
9283
9284 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9285 and images.
9286
9287 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9288 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9289 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9290 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9291 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9292 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9293 of the display margins.
9294
9295 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9296 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9297 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9298 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9299 in this file).
9300
9301 ** Help display
9302
9303 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9304 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9305 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9306 that have a `help-echo' property.
9307
9308 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9309 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9310 the window in which the help was found.
9311
9312 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9313 `help-echo' text property was found.
9314
9315 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9316 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9317
9318 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9319 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9320 mouse.
9321
9322 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9323 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9324
9325 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9326 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9327 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9328 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9329 used as help string.
9330
9331 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9332 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9333 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9334
9335 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9336
9337 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9338 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9339
9340 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9341 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9342 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9343 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9344 used.
9345
9346 (global-set-key [A-down]
9347 #'(lambda ()
9348 (interactive)
9349 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9350 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9351 (global-set-key [A-up]
9352 #'(lambda ()
9353 (interactive)
9354 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9355 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9356
9357 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9358
9359 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9360 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9361 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9362 is called with one argument, POS.
9363
9364 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9365 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9366 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9367 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9368 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9369
9370 ** Tool bar support.
9371
9372 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9373 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9374 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9375 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9376 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9377 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9378
9379 *** Tool bar item definitions
9380
9381 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9382 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9383 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9384
9385 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9386 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9387 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9388 property (see below).
9389
9390 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9391 binding are currently ignored.
9392
9393 The following properties are recognized:
9394
9395 `:enable FORM'.
9396
9397 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9398 or disabled.
9399
9400 `:visible FORM'
9401
9402 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9403
9404 `:filter FUNCTION'
9405
9406 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9407 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9408 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9409
9410 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9411
9412 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9413 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9414
9415 `:image IMAGES'
9416
9417 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9418 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9419 meaning of each of the four elements:
9420
9421 Index Use when item is
9422 ----------------------------------------
9423 0 enabled and selected
9424 1 enabled and deselected
9425 2 disabled and selected
9426 3 disabled and deselected
9427
9428 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9429 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9430
9431 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9432
9433 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9434 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9435
9436 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9437 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9438 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9439 menu bar.
9440
9441 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9442 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9443 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9444
9445 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9446
9447 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9448 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9449 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9450
9451 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9452 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9453
9454 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9455 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9456 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9457 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9458
9459 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9460 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9461
9462 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9463
9464 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9465 a tool bar item. If
9466
9467 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9468 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9469 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9470
9471 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9472
9473 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9474
9475 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9476 item.
9477
9478 ** Mode line changes.
9479
9480 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9481
9482 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9483 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9484 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9485
9486 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9487 a `local-map' text property.
9488
9489 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9490 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9491
9492 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9493 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9494 `local-map' property.
9495
9496 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9497 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9498 example.
9499
9500 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9501 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9502
9503 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9504 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9505
9506 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9507
9508 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9509 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9510 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9511 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9512 line.
9513
9514 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9515 `header-line'.
9516
9517 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9518 position in the header-line.
9519
9520 ** Text property `display'
9521
9522 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9523 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9524 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9525 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9526 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9527
9528 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9529
9530 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9531 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9532
9533 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9534 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9535 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9536 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9537 simpler form STRING as property value.
9538
9539 *** Variable width and height spaces
9540
9541 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9542 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9543 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9544 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9545 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9546 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9547 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9548
9549 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9550 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9551 properties described below.
9552
9553 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9554 characters having the `display' property.
9555
9556 - :width WIDTH
9557
9558 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9559 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9560
9561 - :relative-width FACTOR
9562
9563 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9564 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9565 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9566 width of that character by FACTOR.
9567
9568 - :align-to HPOS
9569
9570 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9571 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9572
9573 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9574
9575 - :height HEIGHT
9576
9577 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9578 normal line height.
9579
9580 - :relative-height FACTOR
9581
9582 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9583 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9584
9585 - :ascent ASCENT
9586
9587 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9588 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9589 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9590 equal to 100.
9591
9592 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9593
9594 *** Images
9595
9596 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9597 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9598 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9599 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9600 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9601 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9602 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9603 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9604 as display specification.
9605
9606 *** Other display properties
9607
9608 - (space-width FACTOR)
9609
9610 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9611 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9612 integer or float.
9613
9614 - (height HEIGHT)
9615
9616 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9617
9618 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9619 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9620 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9621 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9622 a font is available counts as a step.
9623
9624 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9625 as tall as the frame's default font.
9626
9627 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9628 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9629
9630 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9631 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9632
9633 - (raise FACTOR)
9634
9635 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9636 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9637 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9638 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9639 `height' subproperty.
9640
9641 *** Conditional display properties
9642
9643 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9644 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9645 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9646 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9647 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9648 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9649 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9650 different when object is a string.
9651
9652 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9653 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9654
9655 ** New menu separator types.
9656
9657 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9658 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9659 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9660 to specify other menu separator types.
9661
9662 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9663
9664 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9665 separator occurs.
9666
9667 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9668
9669 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9670
9671 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9672
9673 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9674
9675 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9676
9677 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9678
9679 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9680
9681 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9682
9683 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9684
9685 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9686 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9687
9688 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9689
9690 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9691
9692 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9693
9694 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9695
9696 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9697
9698 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9699
9700 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9701
9702 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9703
9704 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9705
9706 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9707
9708 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9709
9710 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9711
9712 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9713
9714 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9715
9716 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9717 the corresponding single-line separators.
9718
9719 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9720
9721 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9722 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9723 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9724 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9725 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9726 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9727 default foreground is black.
9728
9729 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9730 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9731 `ScrollBarBackground').
9732
9733 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9734 settings for scroll bar colors.
9735
9736 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9737 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9738
9739 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9740 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9741 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9742 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9743 the original window start.
9744
9745 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9746 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9747 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9748
9749 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9750
9751 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9752 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9753 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9754 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9755
9756 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9757 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9758
9759 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9760
9761 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9762 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9763 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9764 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9765 temporarily to nil, for example
9766
9767 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9768 (enlarge-window 10))
9769
9770 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9771 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9772
9773 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9774 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9775 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9776 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9777 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9778 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9779
9780
9781 \f
9782 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9783
9784 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9785 input.
9786
9787 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9788
9789 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9790
9791 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9792 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9793 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9794 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9795 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9796
9797 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9798 been added.
9799
9800 \f
9801 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9802
9803 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9804
9805
9806 \f
9807 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9808
9809 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9810 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9811 \f
9812 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9813
9814 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9815
9816 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9817 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9818 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9819
9820 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9821 is the one that is used.
9822
9823 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9824 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9825 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9826 separate from the command's regular output.
9827 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9828 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9829 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9830 the buffer name.
9831
9832 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9833 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9834 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9835 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9836
9837 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9838 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9839 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9840 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9841
9842 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9843 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9844 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9845 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9846
9847 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9848 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9849 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9850 they never ignore case.
9851
9852 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9853 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9854 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9855 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9856 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9857 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9858 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9859
9860 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9861 the same format that was used in the file before.
9862
9863 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9864 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9865
9866 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9867 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9868 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9869
9870 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9871 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9872 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9873 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9874 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9875 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9876 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9877
9878 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9879 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9880 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9881 format. You can now customize these variables.
9882
9883 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9884 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9885 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9886 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9887
9888 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9889 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9890 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9891
9892 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9893 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9894 doesn't have any effect.
9895
9896 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9897 not one per buffer.
9898
9899 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9900 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9901 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9902
9903 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9904 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9905 `auto-show-mode' command.
9906
9907 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9908 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9909 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9910 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9911 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9912
9913 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9914 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9915
9916 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9917 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9918 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9919
9920 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9921 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9922 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9923 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9924
9925 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9926
9927 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9928 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9929 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9930 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9931 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9932
9933 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9934 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9935
9936 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9937 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9938 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9939 `?' on other systems.
9940
9941 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9942 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9943 Unix.
9944
9945 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9946 current codepage when it starts.
9947
9948 ** Mail changes
9949
9950 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9951 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9952 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9953 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9954 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9955 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9956 latin-1:
9957
9958 MIME-version: 1.0
9959 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9960 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9961
9962 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9963 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9964 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9965 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9966 buffer-file-coding-system.
9967
9968 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9969 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9970 mail.
9971
9972 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9973 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9974 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9975 list of possible coding systems.
9976
9977 ** CC Mode changes
9978
9979 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9980 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9981 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9982 docstring for details.
9983
9984 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9985 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9986 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9987 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9988 lineup functions use this feature currently.
9989
9990 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9991 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9992
9993 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9994 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9995
9996 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9997 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9998 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9999 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10000 anonymous classes.
10001
10002 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10003 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10004
10005 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10006 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10007 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10008 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10009
10010 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10011 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10012 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10013 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10014 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10015
10016 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10017
10018 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10019
10020 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10021 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10022
10023 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10024
10025 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10026 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10027 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10028 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10029 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10030
10031 ** Gnus changes.
10032
10033 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10034 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10035 Gnus manual for the full story.
10036
10037 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10038 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10039 group, which is created automatically.
10040
10041 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10042 values.
10043
10044 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10045
10046 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10047 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10048
10049 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10050 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10051
10052 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10053
10054 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10055 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10056
10057 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10058
10059 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10060 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10061
10062 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10063 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10064
10065 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10066 control over simplification.
10067
10068 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10069
10070 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10071 limit.
10072
10073 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10074
10075 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10076
10077 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10078 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10079 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10080
10081 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10082 `a' forces normal posting method.
10083
10084 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10085 -- `W d'.
10086
10087 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10088 to a non-nil value.
10089
10090 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10091 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10092
10093 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10094 has been added.
10095
10096 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10097
10098 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10099
10100 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10101 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10102
10103 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10104 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10105
10106 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10107
10108 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10109 been added.
10110
10111 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10112 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10113
10114 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10115 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10116
10117 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10118
10119 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10120
10121 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10122
10123 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10124
10125 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10126 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10127 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10128
10129 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10130 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10131 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10132 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10133 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10134
10135 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10136 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10137 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10138 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10139
10140 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10141 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10142 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10143 mismatch.
10144
10145 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10146
10147 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10148 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10149
10150 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10151 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10152 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10153 removed from the label.
10154
10155 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10156 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10157
10158 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10159 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10160
10161 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10162 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10163 expressions.
10164
10165 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10166
10167 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10168
10169 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10170 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10171
10172 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10173 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10174 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10175
10176 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10177 changes with a special face.
10178
10179 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10180 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10181 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10182 \f
10183 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10184
10185 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10186 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10187 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10188 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10189 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10190
10191 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10192 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10193 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10194
10195 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10196 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10197 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10198 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10199 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10200 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10201 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10202 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10203 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10204
10205 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10206 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10207 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10208 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10209 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10210 program.
10211
10212 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10213 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10214 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10215 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10216 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10217 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10218
10219 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10220 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10221 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10222 was not documented clearly before.
10223
10224 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10225 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10226 \f
10227 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10228
10229 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10230 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10231 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10232 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10233
10234 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10235 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10236 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10237
10238 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10239
10240 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10241 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10242
10243 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10244 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10245 integers.
10246
10247 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10248 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10249 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10250 file names and attributes are returned.
10251
10252 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10253 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10254 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10255 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10256 returns the result.
10257
10258 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10259 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10260
10261 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10262
10263 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10264 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10265 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10266 optionally.
10267
10268 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10269 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10270
10271 **
10272 The new function process-running-child-p
10273 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10274 terminal to its own child process.
10275
10276 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10277 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10278 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10279 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10280
10281 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10282 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10283
10284 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10285 :included is an alias for :visible.
10286
10287 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10288 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10289 to move or copy menu entries.
10290
10291 ** Multibyte editing changes
10292
10293 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10294 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10295 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10296 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10297 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10298 (setq char (sref str idx)
10299 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10300 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10301
10302 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10303 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10304 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10305
10306 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10307 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10308 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10309
10310 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10311
10312 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10313 across the boundary.
10314
10315 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10316 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10317 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10318 contains 8-bit characters.
10319 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10320 contains invalid characters.
10321
10322 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10323 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10324 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10325 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10326 way.
10327
10328 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10329 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10330 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10331 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10332
10333 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10334 compose Thai characters in a string.
10335
10336 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10337 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10338 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10339 menus should always use the third argument.
10340
10341 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10342 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10343 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10344 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10345
10346 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10347 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10348 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10349 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10350
10351 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10352 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10353 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10354 echo area contents.
10355
10356 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10357
10358 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10359 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10360 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10361
10362 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10363 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10364 means to clear out that attribute.
10365
10366 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10367 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10368
10369 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10370 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10371 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10372 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10373
10374 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10375 the gap of the current buffer.
10376
10377 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10378 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10379 current buffer.
10380
10381 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10382 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10383 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10384 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10385 \f
10386 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10387
10388 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10389 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10390 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10391 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10392 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10393
10394 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10395 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10396 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10397 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10398 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10399
10400 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10401 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10402 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10403
10404 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10405 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10406 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10407 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10408 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10409 results.
10410
10411 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10412 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10413 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10414 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10415 \f
10416 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10417
10418 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10419 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10420 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10421 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10422
10423 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10424 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10425 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10426 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10427 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10428 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10429 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10430 region.
10431
10432 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10433 selective undo.
10434
10435 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10436 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10437 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10438 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10439 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10440
10441 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10442 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10443 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10444 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10445
10446 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10447 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10448 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10449 something that most users not do.
10450
10451 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10452 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10453 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10454 applications.
10455
10456 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10457 pasting operations.
10458
10459 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10460 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10461 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10462 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10463 `ps-printer-name'.
10464
10465 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10466 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10467 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10468 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10469 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10470 hits a new word.
10471
10472 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10473 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10474 to be confused by TeX commands.
10475
10476 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10477 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10478 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10479 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10480
10481 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10482 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10483 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10484 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10485 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10486
10487 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10488 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10489
10490 ** Changes in input method usage.
10491
10492 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10493 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10494 respectively.
10495
10496 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10497
10498 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10499 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10500
10501 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10502 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10503
10504 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10505
10506 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10507
10508 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10509 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10510
10511 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10512 given in the following case:
10513 o When you are using a complex input method.
10514 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10515
10516 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10517 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10518 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10519 setting it to t is helpful.
10520
10521 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10522
10523 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10524 keys:
10525 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10526 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10527 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10528 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10529 environment.
10530
10531 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10532 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10533 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10534 get
10535
10536 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10537
10538 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10539
10540 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10541 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10542
10543 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10544 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10545 its owner and group.
10546
10547 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10548 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10549
10550 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10551 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10552
10553 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10554 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10555 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10556 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10557
10558 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10559 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10560 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10561 for writing keyboard macros.
10562
10563 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10564 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10565 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10566 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10567 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10568 info.
10569
10570 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10571
10572 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10573 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10574 contents only.
10575
10576 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10577 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10578 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10579 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10580
10581 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10582 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10583 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10584
10585 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10586 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10587 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10588 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10589
10590 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10591 failure if the command produces no output.
10592
10593 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10594 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10595 the mouse.
10596
10597 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10598 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10599 function and variable names.
10600
10601 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10602 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10603 file-coding-system-alist.
10604
10605 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10606 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10607 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10608 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10609 according to the current fontset.
10610
10611 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10612
10613 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10614 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10615 nonascii-insert-offset.
10616
10617 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10618 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10619 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10620 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10621
10622 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10623 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10624
10625 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10626 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10627
10628 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10629 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10630 command keys.
10631
10632 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10633 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10634
10635 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10636 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10637 all variables that have documentation.
10638
10639 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10640 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10641 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10642 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10643 it should show; the default is 20.
10644
10645 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10646 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10647 of your input.
10648
10649 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10650 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10651 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10652 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10653 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10654 Newly added options are included as well.
10655
10656 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10657 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10658 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10659
10660 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10661 Customize menu.
10662
10663 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10664 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10665
10666 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10667 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10668 invoked.
10669
10670 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10671 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10672 The default is 1.
10673
10674 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10675 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10676 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10677 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10678 sensibly.
10679
10680 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10681
10682 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10683 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10684 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10685
10686 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10687 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10688 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10689 every night.
10690
10691 ** Desktop changes
10692
10693 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10694 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10695
10696 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10697 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10698
10699 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10700 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10701
10702 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10703 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10704 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10705 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10706 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10707 made invisible again.
10708
10709 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10710
10711 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10712 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10713 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10714 toggle.
10715
10716 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10717 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10718 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10719 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10720 rmail-default-body-file.
10721
10722 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10723 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10724 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10725
10726 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10727 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10728 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10729
10730 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10731 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10732 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10733 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10734 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10735 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10736
10737 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10738 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10739 provided by feedmail are:
10740
10741 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10742 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10743 there is also a queue for draft messages
10744
10745 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10746 be prompted for confirmation
10747
10748 **** does smart filling of address headers
10749
10750 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10751 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10752 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10753
10754 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10755 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10756 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10757 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
10758
10759 ** Dired changes
10760
10761 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10762 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10763
10764 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10765 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10766
10767 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10768 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10769 for a specified regexp.
10770
10771 ** VC Changes
10772
10773 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10774 conveniently.
10775
10776 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10777 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10778 Dired.
10779
10780 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10781 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10782 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10783 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10784
10785 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10786 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10787 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10788 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10789 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10790
10791 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10792 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10793 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10794 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10795 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10796
10797 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10798 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10799 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10800 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10801
10802 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10803 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10804 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10805
10806 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10807 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10808 session to resolve them.
10809
10810 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10811 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10812 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10813 uses as well).
10814
10815 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10816 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10817 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10818 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10819 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10820 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10821 using ediff.
10822
10823 ** Changes in Font Lock
10824
10825 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10826 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10827 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10828 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10829 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10830
10831 ** Frame name display changes
10832
10833 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10834 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10835 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10836 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10837
10838 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10839 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10840 menu.
10841
10842 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10843
10844 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10845 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10846 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10847
10848 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10849
10850 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10851 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10852 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10853
10854 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10855 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10856 the following line.
10857
10858 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10859 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10860 previously sent input.
10861
10862 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10863 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10864 as the search string.
10865
10866 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10867 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10868
10869 ** C mode changes
10870
10871 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10872 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10873 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10874 definition.
10875
10876 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10877 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10878 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10879 style is still the default however.
10880
10881 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10882
10883 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10884 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10885 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10886
10887 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10888 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10889
10890 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10891 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10892
10893 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10894 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10895
10896 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10897 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10898
10899 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10900 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10901 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10902 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10903
10904 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
10905
10906 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10907 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10908 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10909
10910 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10911 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10912 expanding dynamically.
10913
10914 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10915 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10916
10917 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10918 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10919 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10920 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10921
10922 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10923
10924 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10925
10926 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10927 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10928 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10929 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10930 against the first word in the title.
10931
10932 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10933 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10934 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10935 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10936 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10937 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10938
10939 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10940 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10941 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10942 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10943
10944 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
10945
10946 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10947 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10948 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10949 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10950 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10951 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10952
10953 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10954 Editing group once the package is loaded.
10955
10956 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10957 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
10958 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
10959
10960 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10961 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10962
10963 ** Ispell changes.
10964
10965 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10966 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10967 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10968
10969 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
10970 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10971 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10972 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10973 include:
10974
10975 o URLs are automatically skipped
10976 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10977
10978 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10979
10980 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10981
10982 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10983 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10984 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10985 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10986
10987 *** New recursive parser.
10988
10989 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10990 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10991 recursive parser scans the individual files.
10992
10993 *** Parsing only part of a document.
10994
10995 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10996 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10997 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10998
10999 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11000
11001 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11002
11003 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11004
11005 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11006
11007 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11008
11009 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11010 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11011
11012 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11013
11014 *** References to external documents.
11015
11016 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11017 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11018 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11019 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11020 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11021 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11022 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11023
11024 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11025
11026 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11027 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11028
11029 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11030 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11031
11032 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11033
11034 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11035 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11036
11037 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11038
11039 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11040 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11041 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11042 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11043 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11044 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11045 more.
11046
11047 *** Support for the varioref package
11048
11049 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11050
11051 *** New hooks
11052
11053 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11054 and citations are created. These hooks are
11055 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11056 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11057
11058 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11059
11060 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11061 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11062
11063 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11064
11065 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11066 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11067 fontified, use
11068
11069 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11070
11071 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11072 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11073 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11074 directories that contain the same file name.
11075
11076 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11077 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11078 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11079 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11080 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11081 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11082 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11083 directory.
11084
11085 ** New modes and packages
11086
11087 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11088 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11089 it, but some do not.
11090
11091 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11092 code.
11093
11094 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11095 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11096 around in a buffer.
11097
11098 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11099
11100 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11101 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11102 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11103 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11104
11105 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11106 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11107 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11108
11109 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11110 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11111 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11112 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11113 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11114 the like.
11115
11116 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11117 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11118
11119 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11120 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11121 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11122 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11123
11124 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11125
11126 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11127 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11128 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11129 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11130 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11131 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11132 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11133 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11134 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11135 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11136 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11137
11138 Platform-specific modes:
11139
11140 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11141 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11142 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11143 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11144 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11145 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11146 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11147 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11148 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11149 \f
11150 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11151
11152 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11153 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11154 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11155 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11156
11157 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11158 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11159 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11160
11161 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11162 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11163 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11164 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11165
11166 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11167 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11168 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11169 environment.
11170
11171 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11172 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11173 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11174 current input method for reading this one event.
11175
11176 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11177 now control whether to output certain characters as
11178 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11179 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11180 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11181 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11182 \f
11183 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11184
11185 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11186 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11187
11188 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11189 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11190 always increases point by 1.
11191
11192 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11193 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11194
11195 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11196
11197 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11198 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11199 default value changed. For example,
11200
11201 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11202 :type 'integer
11203 :group 'foo
11204 :version "20.3")
11205
11206 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11207 :version "20.3")
11208
11209 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11210 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11211 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11212 `:version' in the top level group.
11213
11214 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11215
11216 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11217 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11218
11219 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11220 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11221 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11222 to themselves.
11223
11224 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11225 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11226 values whatever.
11227
11228 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11229 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11230 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11231
11232 ** Frame-local variables.
11233
11234 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11235 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11236 local bindings for that variable.
11237
11238 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11239 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11240 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11241 parameter name.
11242
11243 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11244 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11245 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11246 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11247
11248 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11249 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11250 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11251 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11252
11253 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11254 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11255 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11256 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11257 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11258
11259 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11260 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11261 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11262 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11263
11264 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11265 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11266
11267 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11268 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11269 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11270
11271 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11272 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11273 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11274 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11275
11276 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11277 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11278 empty input.
11279
11280 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11281 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11282 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11283 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11284 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11285
11286 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11287 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11288 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11289 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11290
11291 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11292 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11293 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11294 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11295 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11296
11297 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11298 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11299 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11300 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11301
11302 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11303 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11304 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11305
11306 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11307 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11308 was directed to display this buffer.
11309
11310 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11311 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11312 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11313 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11314 set-window-configuration.
11315
11316 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11317 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11318 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11319 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11320
11321 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11322 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11323 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11324
11325 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11326 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11327 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11328
11329 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11330 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11331
11332 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11333 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11334
11335 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11336 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11337 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11338
11339 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11340 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11341 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11342 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11343
11344 ** Menu changes
11345
11346 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11347 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11348 better supported.
11349
11350 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11351 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11352 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11353 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11354 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11355
11356 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11357
11358 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11359 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11360 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11361 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11362
11363 The format is:
11364 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11365 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11366 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11367 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11368 The supported properties include
11369
11370 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11371 item is enabled.
11372 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11373 item should appear in the menu.
11374 :filter FILTER-FN
11375 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11376 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11377 It should return a binding to use instead.
11378 :keys DESCRIPTION
11379 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11380 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11381 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11382 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11383 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11384 keyboard binding.
11385 :key-sequence nil
11386 This means that the command normally has no
11387 keyboard equivalent.
11388 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11389 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11390 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11391 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11392 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11393
11394 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11395 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11396
11397 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11398
11399 ** New event types
11400
11401 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11402 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11403 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11404 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11405
11406 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11407
11408 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11409 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11410 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11411 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11412 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11413 forward, away from the user.
11414
11415 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11416
11417 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11418 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11419 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11420 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11421 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11422
11423 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11424
11425 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11426 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11427 that were dragged and dropped.
11428
11429 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11430
11431 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11432
11433 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11434 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11435 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11436
11437 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11438 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11439 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11440
11441 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11442 in Emacs 19 and before.
11443
11444 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11445 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11446
11447 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11448 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11449 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11450 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11451
11452 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11453 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11454 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11455 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11456 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11457
11458 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11459 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11460 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11461 consistent with the new representation.
11462
11463 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11464 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11465 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11466 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11467
11468 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11469 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11470 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11471
11472 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11473 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11474 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11475
11476 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11477 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11478 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11479
11480 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11481 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11482
11483 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11484 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11485
11486 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11487 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11488 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11489 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11490
11491 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11492 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11493
11494 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11495 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11496 buffer or string being searched.
11497
11498 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11499 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11500 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11501 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11502 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11503 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11504 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11505
11506 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11507
11508 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11509 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11510 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11511 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11512 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11513 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11514 define-coding-system-alias.
11515
11516 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11517 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11518 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11519 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11520 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11521 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11522 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11523 `iso-8859-1'.
11524
11525 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11526 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11527 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11528 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11529
11530 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11531 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11532 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11533 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11534
11535 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11536 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11537 This function requires a user interaction.
11538
11539 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11540 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11541 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11542 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11543 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11544 select-safe-coding-system.
11545
11546 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11547 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11548 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11549 was done.
11550
11551 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11552 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11553 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11554
11555 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11556 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11557 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11558 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11559
11560 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11561 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11562 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11563 converted.
11564
11565 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11566 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11567
11568 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11569 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11570 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11571 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11572 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11573 range of characters.
11574
11575 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11576 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11577
11578 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11579 in the current buffer at position POS.
11580
11581 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11582 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11583 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11584 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11585 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11586 binding input-method-function to nil.
11587
11588 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11589 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11590 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11591 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11592 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11593
11594 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11595 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11596
11597 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11598 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11599
11600 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11601 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11602 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11603 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11604 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11605 \f
11606 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11607
11608 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11609 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11610 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11611 tree structure.
11612
11613 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11614 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11615
11616 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11617 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11618 in your .emacs file.)
11619
11620 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11621 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11622
11623 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11624 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11625
11626 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11627 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11628 kills the region.
11629
11630 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11631 delete the character before point, as usual.
11632
11633 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11634 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11635 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11636
11637 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11638 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11639 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11640 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11641 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11642 past.)
11643
11644 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11645 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11646 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11647 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11648 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11649
11650 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11651 and is an alias for it.
11652
11653 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11654 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11655
11656 ** Scrolling changes
11657
11658 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11659 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11660
11661 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11662 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11663 where it started.
11664
11665 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11666 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11667 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11668 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11669
11670 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11671 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11672 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11673 recenters the window.
11674
11675 ** International character set support (MULE)
11676
11677 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11678 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11679 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11680 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11681 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11682 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11683
11684 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11685 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11686 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11687 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11688 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11689
11690 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11691 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11692 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11693 language, to make it possible to type them.
11694
11695 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11696 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11697
11698 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11699 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11700
11701 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11702
11703 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11704
11705 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11706 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11707 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11708 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11709 characters for their work until they want to change.
11710
11711 *** Input methods
11712
11713 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11714 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11715 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11716 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11717 support several input methods.
11718
11719 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11720 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11721 work.
11722
11723 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11724 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11725 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11726 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11727 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11728 letter.
11729
11730 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11731 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11732 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11733 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11734 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11735
11736 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11737 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11738 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11739 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11740
11741 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11742 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11743 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11744 the first guess is wrong.
11745
11746 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11747 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11748
11749 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11750 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11751 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11752 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11753
11754 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11755 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11756 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11757 translate automatically to and from either one.
11758
11759 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11760
11761 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11762 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11763 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11764 what you want.
11765
11766 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11767 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11768 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11769 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11770
11771 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11772 character conversion as well.
11773
11774 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11775
11776 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11777 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11778 requires using many fonts.
11779
11780 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11781 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11782
11783 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11784 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11785 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11786 you would use a font.
11787
11788 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11789 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11790 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11791
11792 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11793 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11794 characters).
11795
11796 *** Defining fontsets.
11797
11798 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11799 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11800 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11801
11802 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11803 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11804 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11805 standard fontset are created automatically.
11806
11807 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11808 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11809 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11810 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11811 name is `fontset-startup'.
11812
11813 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11814 The resource value should have this form:
11815 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11816 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11817 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11818 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11819 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11820 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11821 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11822 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11823 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11824
11825 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11826 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11827 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11828
11829 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11830 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11831 following resource,
11832 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11833 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11834 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11835 Here is the substitution rule:
11836 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11837 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11838 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11839 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11840 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11841
11842 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11843 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11844 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11845
11846 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11847 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11848 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11849 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11850 fontsets.
11851
11852 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11853 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11854
11855 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11856 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11857 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11858 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11859 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11860 system for new files that you create.
11861
11862 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11863 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11864 whole Emacs session.
11865
11866 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11867 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11868 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11869
11870 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11871 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11872 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11873 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11874 coding systems that Emacs supports.
11875
11876 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11877 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11878 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11879 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11880 is used for *the immediately following command*.
11881
11882 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11883 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11884
11885 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11886 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11887
11888 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
11889 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11890
11891 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11892 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11893 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11894 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11895 of the file.
11896
11897 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11898 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11899 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11900 translated into that character code.
11901
11902 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11903 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11904
11905 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11906
11907 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11908 the coding system for keyboard input.
11909
11910 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11911 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11912 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11913
11914 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11915
11916 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11917 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11918 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11919 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11920 designed to work with terminals.
11921
11922 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11923 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11924 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11925 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11926 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11927 in the corresponding buffer.
11928
11929 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11930
11931 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11932 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11933 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11934
11935 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11936 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11937 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11938 want to use.
11939
11940 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11941 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11942
11943 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11944 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11945 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11946 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11947
11948 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11949 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11950 related information.
11951
11952 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11953 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11954 scripts.
11955
11956 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11957 information about the support for a particular language.
11958 You specify the language as an argument.
11959
11960 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11961 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11962 first dash.
11963
11964 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11965 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11966 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
11967 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11968
11969 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11970 B big5 (Chinese)
11971 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11972 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11973 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11974 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11975 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11976 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11977 K euc-korea (Korean)
11978 R koi8 (Russian)
11979 Q tibetan
11980 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11981 T lao
11982 T tis620 (Thai)
11983 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11984 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11985 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11986 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11987 z hz (Chinese)
11988
11989 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11990 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11991 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11992 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11993
11994 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11995 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11996
11997 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11998 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11999 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12000 Rmail files themselves.
12001
12002 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12003 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12004
12005 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12006 for sending mail:
12007
12008 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12009 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12010 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12011 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12012 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12013
12014 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12015 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12016 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12017 translations.
12018
12019 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12020 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12021 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12022 without any conversion.
12023
12024 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12025 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12026 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12027 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12028
12029 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12030 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12031
12032 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12033 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12034
12035 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12036 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12037
12038 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12039 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12040 in the buffer before point.
12041
12042 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12043 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12044 you are using.
12045
12046 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12047 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12048
12049 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12050
12051 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12052 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12053
12054 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12055 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12056 can become a bottleneck.
12057
12058 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12059 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12060 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12061 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12062 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12063 so useful that the change is worth while.
12064
12065 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12066 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12067 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12068 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12069
12070 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12071 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12072 show-paren-mode.
12073
12074 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12075 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12076 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12077
12078 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12079 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12080 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12081
12082 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12083 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12084 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12085
12086 ** Changes in View mode.
12087
12088 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12089 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12090
12091 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12092 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12093
12094 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12095 previous state.
12096
12097 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12098 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12099
12100 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12101 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12102 not just the selected window.
12103
12104 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12105 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12106 turns View mode on or off.
12107
12108 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12109 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12110 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12111
12112 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12113 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12114
12115 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12116 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12117 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12118 which version to compare with.
12119
12120 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12121 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12122
12123 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12124 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12125 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12126 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12127
12128 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12129 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12130 blocks, all of them or none.
12131
12132 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12133 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12134 confirmation first.
12135
12136 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12137 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12138 However, the mode will not be changed if
12139 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12140 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12141 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12142 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12143
12144 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12145
12146 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12147 these commands do not change the major mode.
12148
12149 ** M-x occur changes.
12150
12151 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12152 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12153
12154 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12155 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12156 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12157
12158 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12159 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12160 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12161 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12162 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12163
12164 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12165 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12166 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12167 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12168
12169 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12170 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12171 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12172
12173 ** Outline mode changes.
12174
12175 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12176
12177 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12178
12179 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12180 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12181 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12182 was already active.
12183
12184 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12185 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12186 get confused by it.
12187
12188 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12189 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12190
12191 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12192
12193 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12194 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12195 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12196 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12197
12198 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12199 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12200 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12201
12202 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12203 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12204 values.
12205
12206 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12207 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12208 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12209 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12210
12211 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12212 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12213 can be. The default value is 30.
12214
12215 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12216
12217 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12218 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12219 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12220 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12221 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12222 behavior.
12223
12224 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12225 compose-mail-other-frame.
12226
12227 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12228 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12229 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12230 buffer that shows the original message.
12231
12232 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12233 with separator lines around the contents.
12234
12235 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12236 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12237 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12238 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12239
12240 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12241
12242 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12243 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12244 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12245 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12246
12247 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12248 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12249 /etc/passwd.
12250
12251 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12252 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12253 /etc/passwd.
12254
12255 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12256 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12257 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12258 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12259
12260 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12261 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12262 be taken to be magic.
12263
12264 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12265 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12266 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12267
12268 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12269 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12270
12271 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12272 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12273
12274 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12275
12276 new key dired.el binding old key
12277 ------- ---------------- -------
12278 * c dired-change-marks c
12279 * m dired-mark m
12280 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12281 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12282 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12283 * u dired-unmark u
12284 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12285 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12286 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12287 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12288 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12289 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12290
12291 ** Rmail changes.
12292
12293 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12294 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12295 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12296 each time you run it.
12297
12298 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12299 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12300
12301 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12302 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12303 means to move in the opposite direction.
12304
12305 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12306 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12307
12308 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12309 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12310 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12311 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12312 for output.
12313
12314 ** Gnus changes.
12315
12316 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12317
12318 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12319 Gnus.
12320
12321 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12322 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12323
12324 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12325 article mode line.
12326
12327 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12328
12329 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12330
12331 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12332
12333 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12334 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12335 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12336
12337 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12338
12339 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12340
12341 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12342 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12343
12344 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12345 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12346 used to pick articles.
12347
12348 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12349 another have been added.
12350
12351 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12352
12353 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12354 generating lines in buffers.
12355
12356 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12357 `C-M-_'.
12358
12359 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12360
12361 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12362
12363 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12364
12365 *** Scores can be decayed.
12366
12367 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12368
12369 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12370 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12371
12372 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12373 the native server.
12374
12375 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12376
12377 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12378 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12379
12380 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12381
12382 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12383 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12384
12385 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12386 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12387
12388 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12389 a group.
12390
12391 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12392 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12393
12394 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12395
12396 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12397
12398 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12399
12400 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12401
12402 Use the `Y c' command.
12403
12404 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12405
12406 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12407
12408 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12409
12410 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12411 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12412
12413 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12414
12415 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12416
12417 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12418 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12419
12420 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12421
12422 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12423 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12424 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12425 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12426 this issue.)
12427
12428 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12429 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12430 particular news group. This can be done by:
12431
12432 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12433
12434 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12435 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12436 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12437 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12438 for reading and posting).
12439
12440 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12441 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12442 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12443 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12444 there.
12445
12446 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12447 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12448
12449 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12450 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12451 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12452 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12453 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12454
12455 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12456 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12457
12458 ** CC mode changes.
12459
12460 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12461 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12462 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12463 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12464 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12465 loaded.
12466
12467 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12468 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12469 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12470 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12471 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12472 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12473
12474 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12475 of the current buffer.
12476
12477 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12478 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12479 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12480
12481 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12482 style that the Python developers like.
12483
12484 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12485 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12486 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12487
12488 ** VC Changes [new]
12489
12490 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12491 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12492 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12493
12494 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12495 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12496 developers.
12497
12498 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12499 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12500
12501 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12502 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12503 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12504 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12505
12506 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12507 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12508
12509 ** Calendar changes.
12510
12511 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12512 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12513 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12514 following/previous years.
12515
12516 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12517 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12518 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12519 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12520 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12521 supposed attribute of God.
12522
12523 ** ps-print changes
12524
12525 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12526 layout.
12527
12528 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12529
12530 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12531 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12532 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12533 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12534
12535 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12536 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12537 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12538
12539 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12540 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12541
12542 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12543 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12544 printing for your printer.
12545
12546 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12547 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12548
12549 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12550 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12551
12552 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12553 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12554 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12555 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12556 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12557 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12558 The default value is nil.
12559
12560 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12561 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12562
12563 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12564 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12565 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12566 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12567 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12568 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12569 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12570
12571 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12572 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12573
12574 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12575 The default is 0 ("black").
12576
12577 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12578 The default is 0 ("black").
12579
12580 border-width Specify the border width.
12581 The default is 0.4.
12582
12583 Any other property is ignored.
12584
12585 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12586 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12587 documentation).
12588
12589 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12590 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12591 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12592 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12593 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12594 controlling headers.
12595
12596 *** Color management (subgroup)
12597
12598 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12599 color.
12600
12601 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12602
12603 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12604 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12605 background should be used. Valid values are:
12606
12607 t always use face background color.
12608 nil never use face background color.
12609 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12610
12611 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12612
12613 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12614 sheet of paper.
12615
12616 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12617 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12618
12619 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12620 each page.
12621
12622 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12623 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12624 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12625
12626 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12627 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12628 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12629
12630 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12631 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12632 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12633
12634 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12635 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12636 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12637
12638 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12639 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12640 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12641
12642 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12643
12644 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12645
12646 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12647 RGB color.
12648
12649 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12650 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12651 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12652
12653 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12654 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12655 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12656 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12657 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12658 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12659 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12660 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12661 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12662 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12663 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12664 10 + 10 +
12665 11 + 11 +
12666 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12667 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12668 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12669 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12670 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12671 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12672 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12673 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12674 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12675 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12676 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12677 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12678 22 + 22 +
12679 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12680
12681 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12682
12683
12684 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12685
12686 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12687 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12688 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12689 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12690 to "-P".
12691
12692 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12693 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12694 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12695
12696 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12697 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12698 do so.
12699
12700 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12701
12702 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12703 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12704 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12705 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12706 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12707 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12708 `setpagedevice'.
12709
12710 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12711 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12712 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12713
12714 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12715 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12716 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12717 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12718 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12719 its TO, are ignored.
12720
12721 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12722 pages. Valid values are:
12723
12724 nil print all pages.
12725
12726 `even-page' print only even pages.
12727
12728 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12729
12730 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12731 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12732 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12733 print only the even sheet of paper.
12734
12735 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12736 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12737 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12738 only the odd sheet of paper.
12739
12740 Any other value is treated as nil.
12741
12742 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12743 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12744 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12745
12746 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12747
12748 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12749 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12750
12751 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12752 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12753 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12754 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12755 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12756 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12757 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12758
12759 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12760 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12761 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12762 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12763 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12764 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12765 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12766
12767 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12768
12769 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12770 messages should be sent.
12771
12772 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12773 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12774 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12775
12776 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12777
12778 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12779 points for line numbers.
12780
12781 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12782 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12783
12784 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12785 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12786 to 2, the printing will look like:
12787
12788 1 one line
12789 one line
12790 3 one line
12791 one line
12792 5 one line
12793 one line
12794 ...
12795
12796 Valid values are:
12797
12798 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12799 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12800 is used.
12801
12802 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12803 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12804
12805 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12806
12807 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12808 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12809 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12810 3, the output will look like:
12811
12812 one line
12813 one line
12814 3 one line
12815 one line
12816 one line
12817 6 one line
12818 one line
12819 one line
12820 9 one line
12821 one line
12822 ...
12823
12824 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12825 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12826
12827 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12828 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12829 `ps-font-size').
12830
12831 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12832 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12833 `ps-font-size').
12834
12835 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12836
12837 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12838 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12839
12840 ** hideshow changes.
12841
12842 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12843 C++, ; for lisp).
12844
12845 *** Support for java-mode added.
12846
12847 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12848 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12849
12850 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12851 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12852 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12853
12854 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12855 robust and a lot faster.
12856
12857 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12858
12859 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12860 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12861 documentation for more details.
12862
12863 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12864
12865 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12866 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12867 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12868 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12869 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12870
12871 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12872 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12873 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12874 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12875
12876 ** Font Lock mode
12877
12878 *** Custom support
12879
12880 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12881 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12882 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12883 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12884 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12885 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12886
12887 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12888
12889 *** Maximum decoration
12890
12891 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12892 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12893 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12894 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12895 to get the old behavior.
12896
12897 *** New support
12898
12899 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12900
12901 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12902 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12903
12904 *** Configurable support
12905
12906 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12907 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12908 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12909 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12910 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12911 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12912 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12913
12914 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12915 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12916 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12917
12918 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12919
12920 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12921 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12922 for any mode.
12923
12924 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12925
12926 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12927
12928 in your ~/.emacs.
12929
12930 *** New faces
12931
12932 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12933 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12934 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12935 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12936
12937 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12938
12939 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12940 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12941 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12942
12943 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12944
12945 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12946 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12947 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12948 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12949 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12950 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
12951 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
12952
12953 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12954 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12955 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12956 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12957 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12958 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12959
12960 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12961
12962 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12963 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12964 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12965 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12966
12967 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12968 settings.
12969
12970 ** Ada mode changes.
12971
12972 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12973 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12974 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12975 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12976 stubs.
12977
12978 *** There are two new commands:
12979 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12980 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12981
12982 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12983 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12984 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12985
12986 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12987 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12988 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12989
12990 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12991 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12992 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12993 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12994
12995 ** Scheme mode changes.
12996
12997 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12998 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12999 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13000 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13001 have any effect.
13002
13003 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13004 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13005 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13006 variables as buffer-local variables.
13007
13008 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13009 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13010
13011 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13012
13013 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13014 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13015 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13016 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13017
13018 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13019 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13020 buffer in Emacs.
13021
13022 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13023 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13024 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13025 option takes precedence.
13026
13027 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13028 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13029 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13030
13031 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13032 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13033 the current defun.
13034
13035 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13036 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13037
13038 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13039 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13040 necessary).
13041
13042 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13043 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13044 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13045 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13046 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13047 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13048
13049 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13050 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13051 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13052 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13053
13054 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13055 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13056 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13057 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13058 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13059
13060 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13061 since it applies only to the current frame.
13062
13063 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13064 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13065 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13066
13067 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13068 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13069 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13070 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13071 instead of just the file you are editing.
13072
13073 ** RefTeX mode
13074
13075 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13076 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13077 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13078 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13079 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13080
13081 C-c ( reftex-label
13082 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13083 knows which kind of label is needed.
13084
13085 C-c ) reftex-reference
13086 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13087 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13088
13089 C-c [ reftex-citation
13090 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13091 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13092
13093 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13094 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13095
13096 C-c = reftex-toc
13097 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13098 can quickly jump to every section.
13099
13100 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13101 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13102 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13103 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13104 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13105
13106 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13107
13108 *** Info documentation is now available.
13109
13110 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13111 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13112
13113 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13114 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13115
13116 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13117 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13118
13119 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13120 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13121 appropriate functions.
13122
13123 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13124 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13125
13126 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13127 been cleaned.
13128
13129 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13130 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13131
13132 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13133 shall be delimited.
13134
13135 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13136 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13137 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13138
13139 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13140 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13141 prefixed with `ALT'.
13142
13143 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13144 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13145 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13146 documentation).
13147
13148 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13149 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13150 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13151
13152 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13153 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13154
13155 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13156 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13157 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13158
13159 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13160
13161 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13162
13163 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13164 from alien sources.
13165
13166 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13167 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13168 crossref entries.
13169
13170 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13171 region.
13172
13173 *** Added support for imenu.
13174
13175 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13176 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13177 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13178 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13179
13180 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13181 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13182
13183 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13184
13185 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13186
13187 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13188 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13189 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13190 as an argument.
13191
13192 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13193 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13194
13195 ** browse-url changes
13196
13197 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13198 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13199 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13200 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13201 customization variables.
13202
13203 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13204
13205 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13206 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13207 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13208
13209 ** Changes in Ediff
13210
13211 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13212 pops up the Info file for this command.
13213
13214 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13215 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13216 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13217 directories).
13218
13219 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13220 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13221 files in the same directory.
13222
13223 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13224 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13225 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13226
13227 ** Changes in Viper
13228
13229 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13230 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13231 instead of vip-.
13232 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13233 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13234 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13235 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13236 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13237 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13238 color when Viper is in insert state.
13239 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13240 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13241 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13242
13243 ** Etags changes.
13244
13245 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13246 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13247 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13248 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13249 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13250
13251 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13252
13253 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13254 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
13255
13256 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13257 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13258 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13259
13260 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13261 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13262 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13263 methods and protocols.
13264
13265 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
13266 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13267 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13268 paragraph name.
13269
13270 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13271 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13272 at least M times and as many as N times.
13273
13274 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13275 in files has changed slightly.
13276
13277 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13278 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13279 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13280 with old time-stamp-format values.
13281
13282 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13283 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13284 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13285 reasons.
13286
13287 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13288 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13289 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13290 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13291 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13292 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13293
13294 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13295 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13296 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13297
13298 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13299 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13300 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13301 recommended now will continue to work then.
13302
13303 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13304 details.
13305
13306 ** There are some additional major modes:
13307
13308 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13309 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13310 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13311
13312 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13313 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13314 into Emacs.
13315
13316 ** New Lisp packages include:
13317
13318 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13319
13320 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13321 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13322
13323 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13324
13325 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13326 in shell buffers.
13327
13328 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13329 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13330 and `elint-defun'.
13331
13332 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13333 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13334 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13335 strings or comments.
13336
13337 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13338 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13339 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13340 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13341 at these points.
13342
13343 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13344 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13345
13346 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13347 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13348
13349 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13350
13351 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13352 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13353
13354 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13355
13356 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13357
13358 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13359
13360 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13361 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13362
13363 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13364 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13365 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13366 original place after inserting the copy.
13367
13368 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13369 on the buffer.
13370
13371 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13372 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13373 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13374
13375 Enable mouse-drag with:
13376 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13377 -or-
13378 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13379
13380 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13381 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13382
13383 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13384 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13385
13386 *** ogonek
13387
13388 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13389 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13390 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13391 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13392 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13393 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13394 instance) and vice versa.
13395
13396 To use this package load it using
13397 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13398 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13399 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13400 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13401 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13402 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13403
13404 *** Interface to ph.
13405
13406 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13407
13408 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13409 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13410 these servers.
13411
13412 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13413
13414 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13415 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13416 while the real cursor does not move.
13417
13418 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13419 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13420
13421 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13422 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13423
13424 ** movemail change
13425
13426 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13427 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13428 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13429 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13430
13431 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13432 \f
13433 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13434
13435 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13436
13437 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13438 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13439 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13440 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13441 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13442
13443 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13444 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13445 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13446 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13447 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13448 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13449 \f
13450 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13451
13452 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13453 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13454 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13455 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13456
13457 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13458 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13459
13460 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13461 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13462 "win".
13463
13464 ** Basic Lisp changes
13465
13466 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13467 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13468
13469 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13470 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13471 or by the user.
13472
13473 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13474
13475 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13476
13477 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13478 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13479
13480 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13481 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13482 its argument.
13483
13484 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13485
13486 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13487
13488 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13489
13490 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13491 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13492 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13493 `format' function.
13494
13495 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13496 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13497 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13498
13499 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13500 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13501 adding one of these suffixes.
13502
13503 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13504 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13505 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13506
13507 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13508 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13509
13510 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13511
13512 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13513 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13514
13515 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13516 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13517
13518 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13519
13520 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13521 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13522
13523 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13524 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13525 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13526 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13527
13528 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13529 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13530 of the last form.
13531
13532 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13533 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13534 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13535 as the last form.
13536
13537 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13538 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13539 matches.
13540
13541 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13542
13543 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13544 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13545 Then it returns that string.
13546
13547 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13548
13549 (with-output-to-string
13550 (princ "The buffer is ")
13551 (princ (buffer-name)))
13552
13553 returns "The buffer is foo".
13554
13555 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13556 is non-nil.
13557
13558 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13559 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13560 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13561
13562 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13563 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13564
13565 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13566 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13567 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13568 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13569 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13570 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13571
13572 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13573 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13574 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13575 characters".
13576
13577 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13578 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13579 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13580 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13581 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13582
13583 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13584 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13585 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13586 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13587
13588 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13589 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13590
13591 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13592
13593 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13594 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13595 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13596 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13597 guaranteed.
13598
13599 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13600 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13601 character).
13602
13603 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13604
13605 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13606 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13607 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13608 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13609 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13610
13611 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13612
13613 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13614 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13615 more than the number of characters.
13616
13617 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13618 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13619 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13620 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13621 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13622 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13623
13624 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13625 and returns a string containing those characters.
13626
13627 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13628 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13629 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13630 character, sref signals an error.
13631
13632 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13633 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13634 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13635
13636 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13637 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13638 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13639
13640 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13641 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13642 to a vector of the characters in it.
13643
13644 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13645 of a string. You call it as follows:
13646
13647 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13648
13649 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13650 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13651 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13652 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13653 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13654
13655 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13656 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13657
13658 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13659 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13660
13661 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13662 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13663 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13664 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13665
13666 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13667
13668 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13669
13670 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13671 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13672 are not included in the resulting value.
13673
13674 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13675 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13676 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13677 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13678
13679 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13680 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13681 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13682 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13683 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13684 column START-COLUMN.
13685
13686 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13687 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13688 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13689 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13690 changed text, before the change.
13691
13692 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13693 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13694 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13695
13696 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13697
13698 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13699
13700 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13701 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13702
13703 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13704 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13705 which identify the character within that character set.
13706
13707 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13708 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13709 opposite of split-char.
13710
13711 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13712 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13713
13714 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13715 of all the characters in a string.
13716
13717 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13718 and specifying coding systems.
13719
13720 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13721 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13722 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13723 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13724 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13725 as what to do about code conversion.)
13726
13727 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13728 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13729
13730 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13731 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13732 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13733
13734 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13735 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13736 to match against a file name.
13737
13738 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13739 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13740 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13741 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13742 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13743 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13744
13745 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13746 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13747
13748 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13749 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13750
13751 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13752 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13753 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13754 service names.
13755
13756 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13757 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13758 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13759 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13760 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13761 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13762
13763 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13764 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13765
13766 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13767 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13768 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13769 start the subprocess.
13770
13771 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13772 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13773 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13774 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13775 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13776
13777 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13778 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13779 subprocess.
13780
13781 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13782 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13783 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13784 connection permanently or until overridden.
13785
13786 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13787 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13788 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13789 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13790 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13791 system for one operation at a time.
13792
13793 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13794 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13795
13796 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13797 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13798 The value is a cons cell,
13799 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13800 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13801 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13802 input to the subprocess.
13803
13804 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13805 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13806
13807 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13808 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13809 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13810
13811 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13812 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13813 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13814 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13815 customization.
13816
13817 Thus, instead of writing
13818
13819 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13820 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13821
13822 you would now write this:
13823
13824 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13825 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13826 :type 'boolean
13827 :group foo)
13828
13829 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13830 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13831 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13832 for a description of them.
13833
13834 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13835 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13836
13837 (defgroup ispell nil
13838 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13839 :group 'processes)
13840
13841 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13842 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13843 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13844 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13845 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13846
13847 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13848 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13849 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13850 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13851 first-level subgroups.
13852
13853 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13854
13855 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13856 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13857
13858 ** easy-mmode
13859
13860 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13861 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13862 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13863 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13864 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13865 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13866
13867 ** Text property changes
13868
13869 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13870 text property.
13871
13872 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13873 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13874 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13875 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13876 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13877
13878 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13879 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13880 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13881 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13882
13883 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13884 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13885 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13886
13887 ** Changes in invisibility features
13888
13889 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13890 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13891 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13892 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13893 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13894 make the overlay visible.
13895
13896 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13897 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13898 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13899 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13900 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13901 t when it should hide it.
13902
13903 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13904
13905 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13906 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13907 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13908 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13909 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13910 Here is an example of how to do this:
13911
13912 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13913 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13914 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13915 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13916
13917 ...
13918 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13919
13920 ...
13921 ;; When done with the overlays:
13922 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13923 ;; Or respectively:
13924 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13925
13926 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
13927
13928 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13929 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13930 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13931 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13932
13933 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13934 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13935 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13936
13937 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13938 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13939
13940 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13941 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13942
13943 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13944 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13945 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13946
13947 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13948 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13949 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13950 determine the syntax type of the character.
13951
13952 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13953 of the current buffer.
13954
13955 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13956 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13957 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13958
13959 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13960 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13961 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13962 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13963 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13964
13965 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13966 text property.
13967
13968 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13969 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13970 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13971
13972 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13973 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13974 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13975 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13976 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13977
13978 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13979 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13980 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13981
13982 ** Changes in face features
13983
13984 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13985 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13986
13987 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13988 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13989
13990 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13991 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13992
13993 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13994 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13995
13996 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13997 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13998 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13999 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14000 overlay property).
14001
14002 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14003 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14004
14005 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14006
14007 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14008 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14009 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14010 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14011
14012 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14013 begins with ~.
14014
14015 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14016 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14017
14018 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14019 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14020
14021 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14022 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14023
14024 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14025 character code conversion as well as other things.
14026
14027 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14028 (formerly it did not).
14029
14030 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14031 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14032
14033 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14034 instead of constant strings.
14035
14036 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14037 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14038 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14039
14040 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14041 in the same way as before.
14042
14043 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14044 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14045 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14046
14047 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14048 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14049 else, and returns nil.
14050
14051 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14052 directory cannot be listed.
14053
14054 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14055
14056 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14057 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14058 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14059 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14060 ways:
14061
14062 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14063 It is available through the history command M-n.
14064
14065 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14066 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14067 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14068 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14069 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14070
14071 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14072 argument in this way.
14073
14074 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14075 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14076 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14077
14078 ** Echo area features
14079
14080 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14081 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14082 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14083 after the echo area is cleared.
14084
14085 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14086 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14087
14088 ** Keyboard input features
14089
14090 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14091 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14092
14093 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14094 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14095 by keyboard macros.
14096
14097 ** Frame-related changes
14098
14099 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14100 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14101 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14102
14103 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14104 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14105 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14106
14107 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14108 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14109 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14110 in the selected frame.
14111
14112 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14113 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14114 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14115
14116 ** X Windows features
14117
14118 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14119 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14120 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14121
14122 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14123 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14124
14125 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14126 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14127 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14128
14129 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14130 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14131
14132 ** Subprocess features
14133
14134 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14135 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14136 automatically.
14137
14138 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14139 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14140
14141 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14142 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14143
14144 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14145 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14146
14147 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14148 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14149 goes after the other menu items.
14150
14151 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14152 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14153 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14154 are in use.
14155
14156 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14157 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14158
14159 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14160 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14161 form.
14162
14163 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14164 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14165 but its hook is still run.
14166
14167 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14168 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14169
14170 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14171 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14172 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14173
14174 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14175 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14176 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14177 warned.
14178
14179 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14180 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14181
14182 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14183 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14184 functions like display-time.
14185
14186 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14187 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14188
14189 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14190 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14191 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14192
14193 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14194 if there is an error in compilation.
14195
14196 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14197 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14198 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14199 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14200
14201 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14202 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14203 the *scratch* buffer.
14204
14205 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14206 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14207 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14208 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14209
14210 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14211 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14212 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14213
14214 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14215 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14216 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14217 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14218
14219 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14220 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14221 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14222
14223 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14224 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14225 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14226 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14227 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14228 files at all.
14229
14230 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14231 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14232 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14233 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14234
14235 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14236 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14237 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14238 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14239
14240 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14241
14242 ** imenu.el changes.
14243
14244 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14245 item from menu created by imenu.
14246
14247 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14248 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14249 select one of those items.
14250 \f
14251 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14252
14253 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14254 Copyright information:
14255
14256 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14257
14258 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14259 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14260 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14261 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14262
14263 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14264 of this document, or of portions of it,
14265 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14266 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14267 \f
14268 Local variables:
14269 mode: outline
14270 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14271 end:
14272
14273 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793